DepEd EASE Modules General Science Combined PDF
DepEd EASE Modules General Science Combined PDF
DepEd EASE Modules General Science Combined PDF
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 1
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 1
Everyday Science
What is science? What is technology? You know that science and technology are
fields of study which are full of wonders and amazing discoveries. Today’s world is an
environment equipped with sophisticated machineries, which are brought about by the
impact of science and technology.
Before you can understand the works of scientists, you must have a full grasp of what
science is. An understanding of science and its processes must be an integral part of our
daily life activities.
1. give the operational definitions of science, technology, matter and its examples;
2. discuss the impact of science and technology in daily life;
3. analyze local superstitious beliefs, practices and their influences on how problems
are solved in daily life; and
4. appreciate the contributions and desirable traits of outstanding scientists, both foreign
and local.
2
How to learn from this module
Term Definition
A. In the box below are 5 categories. Identify the category to which each given
superstitious belief belongs: (5 pts.)
3
1) Mang Pedro is a fisherman.
He goes out to the sea every
night except during full moon. He
says he’ll never get a good catch
during full moon because the
fairies are around. To which
category does this belong?
____________________
4
B. Technology is either a way or manner of doing things called process or it may be
the finished material called product or tools/gadgets. Classify the following
technologies by writing it to its appropriate category. (12 pts.)
C. Write the correct answer on the space provided before the number.
5
Lesson 1 Doing Some Science Activities
Do you know that science is fun? Try to work on these activities and experience the
enjoyment that science could bring you.
Fill the boxes with the missing letters of the word being described across or
downward.
1 2 3
Across Down
6
7) the capacity or the ability to do work
8) the basic unit of matter
9) an educated guess
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
2) List down three examples of matter found at home. State whether it is in the form of
solid, liquid or gas. Give their uses.
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
3) Based on your examples of matter, how do you define matter? What do you call the
smallest particle of matter?
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________________________
7
4) Suppose you want to find out the factors that could affect the growth of plants, what
you usually do is to hypothesize. What is your idea about hypothesis?
____________________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________________
Enclose the group of letters, which describes the attitudes of scientists and
their way of doing things. The words can be read vertically, horizontally, diagonally
and/or backwards.
H U M B L E X O P E N Y M I N D E D R Z
O V G N F Z W T I O K N L B C S F L Q U
N B K L O G I C A L W A I O Y Z B P O W
E R I U M V R R H Y N N M S J K O N P N
S J O F B B K E J O E P T U X I A C E J
T U M E Y Z X A I K T E H P A T I E N T
S D W R J C S T L U M P L R F Y W Q N R
O G F A W O A I E A F H H O N S N R C K
P M O C D R I V T V C P S C U R I O U S
T E G W F P S I M X B K R E C H E I A D
N N L O I A C T P A V E A S Z W T R C E
X T P N T R X Y O U R R E S P E C T M B
8
What you will do
Self-Test 1.2
Based from the scientific attitudes formed in the word grid, answer the following
questions:
Relate each scientific attitude identified in the word grid to the study of science.
1. __________________________________________________________
2. __________________________________________________________
3. __________________________________________________________
4. __________________________________________________________
5. ___________________________________________________________
For sure the words “science” and “technology” have an impact in your life. You know
very well that science refers to a highly organized and systematic body of knowledge from
which all other concepts or ideas come from.
9
Yet, knowledge alone, if not applied, is practically useless. For example, we learn to
appreciate the usefulness of wheels when these are attached to cabinets, TV racks and
refrigerators, and moving these appliances becomes easy.
We usually follow a procedure in performing each activity listed in the table below.
For each activity, write the procedure followed and the material used in the
appropriate column.
Swimming
Taking a bath
Eating breakfast
Going to school
Studying
10
Gardening
Relaxing at home
Writing a letter
Life in the last century is very different from life as we know it these days. For
example in earlier times, radio and telephone were the most commonly used media to
communicate and inform the people about events in our country and abroad.
Today, how do people communicate and get informed about the happenings here
and abroad? We rely on cellular phones, TV with cables, Internet, e-mail and many more
technologies. To know more about these technologies that make life easier try to perform
Activity 2.2.
11
What you will do
Activity 2.2 The Gadgets that Make Life Easier
Fill out the table below by listing at least 10 technologies in the first column
and the use/s of each technology in the second column.
Technology Use/s
However there are some technologies that can bring more harm than good to people
and environment. Living things and the environment suffer from the consequences of such
technologies. Can you name at least 3 of these technologies?
12
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Name at least one recent discovery in each of the following fields and briefly describe them.
1. Medicine
2. Astronomy
3. Telecommunication
Superstitious beliefs and practices are part of our culture. You learn about them from
your relatives and friends from different places.
Here are some of the superstitious beliefs and practices that Filipinos hold:
1. When there is thunderstorm, you should cover mirrors with cloth so that this
will not be struck by lightning.
2. Bad spirits are roaming around when the dog howls. Some believe that when a
dog howls, something may happen like death of a family member or a
neighbor.
3. When you move to a new house, the first thing to be brought is a sack of rice
because this would mean good luck or prosperity.
4. The sisters or brothers in a family should not get married in the same year
because only one of them will experience good fortune while the other will
experience hardship during their married lives.
All superstitious beliefs have no scientific basis yet they greatly influence your way of
thinking and doing things.
Our ancestors did not clearly understand the causes of many things in their
environment. The occurrence of events was thought to be bringing either good luck or bad
luck. However, with the advent of science and technology, we have learned to investigate
and interpret events scientifically.
The succeeding activity will give you more information about these beliefs and
practices.
13
What you will do
Activity 3.1 Superstitious Beliefs
A. List down about 5 superstitious beliefs, which are still practiced in your
community.
Superstitious Beliefs
Example: A black cat, which suddenly crosses our path, signifies bad luck.
Start here:
You are the eldest child in the family. You were made to decide what color
of dress should be worn during a funeral of an immediate member of the family.
Will it be white or will it be black? Why?
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
1)
2)
Key to answers on page 20
14
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
2) Getting married on a full moon spells a happy and fruitful marriage, especially when it
falls on the 8th day of the month. Do you believe on this? Explain.
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
Our comfortable and easy lifestyles are the results of the hardwork of some
scientists. These people possess certain admirable traits that are worth imitating. You can
identify some of these desirable traits through this activity.
15
What you will do
Activity 4.1 Scientists and their Scientific Attitudes
A. Find out the traits scientists demonstrate from the given information about
them. Write it under the second column.
Scientist Trait
16
inheritance of hypersensitivity to a
disease in maize. He is a man who
accepts statement as a fact only if it
is supported by convincing proofs.
What scientific trait did he possess?
Let’s summarize
17
Posttest
A. Superstitious beliefs could be categorized into five (5) groups such as food and
nutrition, health and medicine, livelihood, love and marriage, and financial or
wealth. To which category does each of these superstitious beliefs belong?
1) During birthday celebration pancit or spaghetti is always served for long life.
2) Single ladies should not sing while cooking because they will marry an old
bachelor.
3) You should not sleep if your hair is still wet because you will get blind.
4) Do not sweep the floor during nighttime because it will give you bad luck.
5) During New Year’s Eve serve 12 different kinds of round fruits to bring in good
luck for the entire year.
1) airplane 7) pencil
2) baking 8) clothes
3) paper 9) boiling
4) computer 10) coffee
5) dyeing 11) brushing
6) evaporation 12) toothpaste
13) broom
C. Read the situation below then write your views or opinion about it in 5
sentences. (3 pts.)
D. Write the correct answer on the space provided before the number.
18
Key to Answers
Pretest
A.
1) Livelihood
2) Financial or Wealth
3) Health and Medicine
4) Love and Marriage
5) Food and Nutrition
B.
C.
1) Science
2) Hypothesis
3) Matter
4) Superstitious Beliefs
5) Technology
6) William Padolina
7) Johannes Kepler
8) Sir Isaac Newton
19
Activity 1.1
1 2 3
M A T T E R F
4
E B I O L O G Y
5
S C I E N C E R
6
H L C E L L S
N I E
7
O E N E R G Y
L F
8
A T O M S S
G
9
H Y P O T H E S I S
Self-Test 1.1
Activity 1.2
H U M B L E X O P E N Y M I N D E D R Z
O V G N F Z W T I O K N L B C S F L Q U
N B K L O G I C A L W A I O Y Z B P O W
E R I U M V R R H Y N N M S J K O N P N
S J O F B B K E J O E P T U X I A C E J
T U M E Y Z X A I K T E H P A T I E N T
S D W R J C S T L U M P L R F Y W Q N R
O G F A W O A I E A F H H O N S N R C K
P M O C D R I V T V C P S C U R I O U S
T E G W F P S I M X B K R E C H E I A D
N N L O I A C T P A V E A S Z W T R C E
X T P N T R X Y O U R R E S P E C T M B
20
Self-Test 1.2
A.
1. honest
2. humble
3. creative
4. logical
5. open-minded
B. (Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their
answers may vary)
Rubric Scoring
2- Give at least two correct descriptions of the given scientific attitude as applied
to the study of science.
1- Give one correct description of the given scientific attitude but with some
grammatical errors.
0- Give incorrect description of the specified scientific attitude.
Activity 2.1
(Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
Activity 2.2
(Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
Self-Test 2.1
(Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
Example: In Medicine - A Laser Probe was discovered, which could detect 90% of
pre-cancerous cells. LASER stands for Light Amplification by Stimulated Emission of
Radiation.
Rubric Scoring
2- Give two or more correct descriptions of the discovery in a specified field like
medicine. Use correct grammar.
1- Give one correct description of the discovery with no grammatical error.
21
0- Give incorrect description of the discovery in a certain field.
Activity 3.1
A. (Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
B. (Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
Rubric Scoring
2- No right answer. It could be white or black. Give correct justification and with
no grammatical errors.
1- Give correct justification with some grammatical errors.
0- No justification for the answer.
Self-Test 3.1
2. I don’t believe because a happy and fruitful marriage depends upon the good
relationships between the couple.
Activity 4.1
1) He is curious.
2) He is open-minded.
3) He is intellectually honest.
4) She is resourceful.
5) He exhibits rationality.
6) He has careful judgment.
Post-test
A.
1) Food and Nutrition
2) Love and Marriage
3) Health and Medicine
4) Livelihood
5) Livelihood
22
B.
1) Product
2) Process
3) Product
4) Product
5) Process
6) Process
7) Product
8) Product
9) Process
10) Product
11) Process
12) Product
13) Tool
C. (Note: The teacher is given the option to check student’s responses. Their answers
may vary.)
Rubric Scoring
3- Give two advantages and one disadvantage of putting up nuclear power plant.
Give correct justification with no grammatical errors.
2- Give one advantage and one disadvantage with no grammatical errors.
1- Give one advantage and one disadvantage with grammatical errors.
0- No correct answer.
D.
1) Galileo Galilie
2) Technology
3) Open-mindedness
4) Superstitious Beliefs
-End of Module-
23
References
Gebelein, C.G. (2001). Chemistry and our world. USA: WCB Wm. C. Brown Publishers
Payawal, P., et. al. (1992). Discoverer Science. Quezon City: Academe Publishing House
Salmorin, L. M. and Florido, B. (2003). Science and Technology IV. Quezon City: Abiva Publishing House Inc.
Tan, M. et. al. (2000). TIMSS-LIKE Test Items in Science and Mathematics. Manila:DOST-SEI, UPNISMED
Pundasyon para sa mga Guro ng Agham at Matematika, Ink.
Villamil, A. and Sinugbuhan R. (2003). Integrated Science I. Quezon City: Abiva Publishing House, Inc.
24
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 2
1
Module 2
Basic Science Processes
There are things around us that we take for granted. For example, if you will be asked
to describe your favorite school bag, most likely you can only describe its general physical
appearance but not the exact size and the type of materials used. In other words, you
cannot readily give the exact description of the object.
This module will guide you on how to be more observant of the things around you.
Keen observation is one way of understanding science processes like measuring,
computing, inferring, generalizing and drawing conclusions. These science processes can
help you acquire and develop higher order thinking skills.
This module contains some activities that can help you enhance your basic science
processes. Remember that through these science processes, you can improve your
problem solving capability.
2
5. organize, compare, interpret data and present conclusions in the form of charts,
tables or graphs.
Term Definition
Convert - to change
Conversion Factor - a ratio or factor used to convert units
Inference - interpretations based on observations
Observations - actual perceptions of the senses
π - read as “pi” having a value of 3.1416
Qualitative Observation - an observation based on quality only
Quantitative Observation - an observation based on quantity only
X-axis - the horizontal line in a graph representing
independent variable
Y-axis - the vertical line in a graph representing
dependent variable
Water Displacement - way of determining the volume of an irregular
Method solid through the volume of its displaced liquid
Least Count - is the smallest value that a measuring device
could measure
3
What to do before (Pretest)
A piece of candle was observed by a first year class before, during and after it was
lighted. The observations were tabulated as follows:
a. 1 and 3 only
b. 2 and 4 only
c. 1 and 4 only
d. 2 and 3 only
a. 1 and 2 only
b. 3 and 4 only
c. 1 and 3 only
d. 2 and 4 only
4
3. Which of the statements in the second column are ”not” qualitative observations?
a. 1 and 2 only
b. 3 and 4 only
c. 1 and 3 only
d. 2 and 4 only
4. How many small lines are there from 0 to 1 cm? Refer to the illustration below
0 1 2 3
cm
a. 4 lines c. 8 lines
b. 6 lines d. 10 lines
5. If 1/4 means 1 out of 4 equal parts, 1/10 means 1 out of how many equal parts?
a. 4 parts
b. 6 parts
c. 8 parts
d. 10 parts
a. 0.001
b. 0.01
c. 0.1
d. 1.0
a. 0.35 mm
b. 3.50 mm
c. 35.0 mm
d. 350.0 mm
5
For questions 8-9, refer to these data on the mass and dimension of the aluminum
block.
length, L = 90 cm width, W = 50 cm
mass, m = 24 g thickness, T = 20 cm
10. Rita poured 20 cc of water in a graduated cylinder. She dropped a piece of stone into
it. The level of water in the graduated cylinder rose to 28 cc. How much is the volume
of the stone?
a. 10 cc c. 6 cc
b. 8 cc d. 4 cc
11. Sally is assigned to make 9 pieces of bouquet for her sister’s wedding. If one bouquet
needs 0.3 m of ribbon, how many centimeters of ribbon is she going to buy?
a. 240 cm
b. 250 cm
c. 270 cm
d. 280 cm
For question numbers 12-18, refer to the situation and the table below:
The students are performing an experiment on displacement method to find out the
relationship between the mass of washers against its volume. The data gathered are the
following: mass of washer = 8 g; volume of 1 washer = 2 cc; initial volume of water in the
graduated cylinder is 20 cc.
6
12. If they add one more washer to make 6 washers, what will be the new mass and
volume?
a. 48 g and 32 cc
b. 48 g and 30 cc
c. 56 g and 28 cc
d. 56 g and 26 cc
13. Which variables do they need to use if they are going to plot the data on a graph?
a. mass of washer
b. volume of washer
c. volume of water
d. number of washers
16. Plot the values of the mass of washers against the volume of water. Describe the
graph.
y (mass)
x (volume)
17. What happens to the volume of water as the mass of washer decreases?
a. Increases
b. Decreases
c. Remains the same
d. Undetermined
7
18. Which of the following interpretations best describes the graph line?
19. Why is the SI system more acceptable than the English system?
There are many things around us that need a closer look. It is when we take a long,
hard look that we are actually observing. Observation involves all of your basic sense
organs: the eyes, nose, ears, tongue, and hands. In an observation, you do not only look,
you have to stare; you don’t only hear, you listen, you don’t only taste and smell, you
savor; and you don’t only touch, you feel.
Most of the time however, you think you are observing when in fact you are inferring.
While observation is actually seeing, smelling, hearing, tasting and touching, inferring is
making interpretations based on your past observations or experiences. You call this an
inference. To help you differentiate between observation and inference, let us do an
activity.
8
What you will do
Activity 1.1 When do you observe and when do you infer
Read the situation in the box, and then write your observations and inferences
on the table below.
You noticed a group of 3 boys and 3 girls talking, laughing and eating on a
table. One boy wears a coat and tie while the other 2 boys dress casually. One of
the girls wears a gown, while the other girls wear ordinary dresses. As they talk,
the boy with the coat and tie places his right arm over the shoulder of the girl
wearing the gown. The two other boys shake hands with the two other girls.
Suddenly, one of the girl cries, while the boys dressed ordinarily argue in high
tones. The pair who wore formal attire talks to the boys. Then they all walk away
from each other in pairs.
Observations Inferences
Ex. A group of 3 boys and 3 girls are Ex. These 3 boys and 3 girls are best
talking, laughing and eating on the friends.
table.
1. 1.
2. 2.
3. 3.
4. 4.
5. 5.
9
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
10
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1 Differentiating Quantitative Observations from Qualitative
Observations
On the right side column of the table below, write the quantitative observation
relevant to the qualitative observation given.
When you quantify your observations, you need to use some mathematical concepts like
measurement and formulas for determining the area and volume of objects.
11
Measurement
The development of science processes starts from the very simple process of
observing to the most complex process of experimenting. Some processes like measuring,
computing, predicting and interpreting data will help you develop your mathematical skills.
Try to perform the succeeding activities that will enhance your mathematical skills.
1. Get a ruler and compare its calibration with the illustration given below.
0 1 2 3
cm
Observation:
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
2. How many smaller lines are there in one centimeter? One line is equal to one
millimeter. How many millimeters are there in one centimeter?
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
3. Look at your ruler again. What is the smallest length that your ruler could measure?
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
12
Length is actually the distance between two points. Width, height and thickness are
also the measured distance between 2 points.
The area and the volume of regularly shaped solids are measured using any of the
devices for length. Let’s say, if the solid is rectangular in shape, its area is found by getting
the product of its length and width (A = Length x Width) and its volume is determined by
getting the product of its length, width, and thickness (V = Length x Width x Thickness). The
final answer for the measured area and volume is based on the minimum number of
significant digits required. Therefore, rounding off of numbers to a certain place value
applies.
For example: Compute the area of a metal block 4.7 mm long and 3.1 mm wide.
Area of a Rectangle
The area of the rectangle is equal to the product of the length (L) and width (W) or
A = LW. Example: Solve for the area of the rectangle with the given dimensions.
L = 3.6 cm
W = 1.8 cm
A=LxW
A = 3.6 cm X 1.8 cm
A = 6.48 cm2
A = 6.5 cm2
13
Area of a Square
The area of the square is equal to the square of the side or A = s2 as shown below.
S = 2 cm
A = S2
A = 2 cm x 2 cm
A = 4 cm2
Area of a Circle
The area of a circle is equal to pi times the square of the radius or A = πr2. The value
of pi (π) is equal to 3.14 while a radius is one-half of a diameter.
For example: Solve for the area of the circle with the diameter of 100 mm. Obviously,
the radius is 50 mm.
A = πr2
= 3.14 x (50 mm)2
Diameter =
2
= 3.14 (2500 mm ) 100 mm
= 7850 mm2
14
Example:
Find the volume of a rectangular metal block 4.7 mm long, 3.1 mm wide and 0.9 mm
thick.
Volume = L x W x H
V = 4.7 mm x 3.1 mm x 0.9 mm
V = 13.113 mm3
V = 13.1 mm3
Volume of a Cube
Volume of a Cylinder
r
2 2
V = 3.14 x radius x height or V = πr h.
The mass of an object is measured using beam, platform, or triple beam balances.
The accuracy of the mass of an object is based on the least count that the device could
give.
For example, the platform balance has a least count of a tenth of a gram, thus, the
final answer for the measured mass is up to one decimal place of a gram.
For example: What is the total mass of the object if the readings of the riders in a
platform balance show 15.0 g and 4.3 g respectively?
Solution:
+ 15.0 g
4.3 g
19.3 g
15
What you will do
Self-Test 2.2
1-2. A rectangular box has the following measurements: length 25 cm, width 10 cm and
height 5 cm. Find its area and its volume.
3. The diameter of a circle is 10 cm. Compute for its area.
4. What is the side of the square if its area is 16 cm2?
5. The mass of the three books is 2.5 kg. What is the total mass in g?
For example, if 10 mm = 1 cm you may write the conversion factor using any one of
the following forms:
1. Convert 125 mm to cm
In this case, form 1 factor is used because the desired unit is centimeter.
2. Convert 35 cm to mm
35 cm x 10 mm = 350 or 350 mm
1 cm 1
In this case form 2 factor is used because the desired unit is millimeter.
16
What you will do
Activity 3.1:
1 cm = 10 mm
1 cg = 10 mg
1 inch = 2.54 cm
30 days = 1 month
1 week = 7 days
1 kilogram = 1000 g
100 cm = 1 m
17
1000 m = 1 km
Convert the following units using the conversion factors in the preceding
discussion:
Examples:
275 g x 1 kg = 0.275 kg
1000 g
18
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
Convert the following values to the desired values using the conversion factors
discussed earlier:
The scientific world has recognized the metric or the SI as the more acceptable
system than the English System because of its convenience in changing the given unit to
the desired unit. The metric system uses prefixes as shown in the table below.
Prefixes Equivalent
Mega 106 or 1000000
Kilo 103 or 1000
Hecto 102 or 100
Deka 101 or 10
Deci 10-1 or 0.1
Centi 10-2 or 0.01
Milli 10-3 or 0.001
Micro 10-6 or 0.000001
These prefixes are used in expressing the metric units of the different physical
quantities. Below are examples of physical quantities that could be expressed using these
prefixes.
19
a. Unit of Length
10 millimeters = 1 centimeter
10 centimeters = 1 decimeter
10 decimeters = 1 meter
b. Unit of Mass
Sample Conversions:
Conversion factors:
1000 g/ 1 kg
1000 mm/1 m
Change:
a. 35 g to kg = 35 g x 1 kg = 35 = 0.035 kg
1000 g 1000
1. 0.75 m to cm =
2. 84 g to kg =
3. 500 cm to mm =
4. 20 days to hours =
5. 5 hours to seconds =
20
Scientific Notation
In science, scientists are concerned with small and big numbers, say for instance this
number 9,450,000,000,000 can be written using power- of- ten notation such as 9.45 x 1012
while this very small number 0.00000000000036 can be written as 3.6 x 10-13.
The use of power-of- ten notation in the writing of numbers is also called exponential
notation. Such number follows the standard form:
N = a x 10b
where N is the given number, a is the number having a single nonzero digit to the left
of the decimal point and b is the positive or the negative exponent.
1. 0.00055
2. 350000000
3. 0.00000000078
4. 5075
5. 4000000000000
21
Lesson 5 Interpretation of Data
All data in any experiments should be well organized for easy and objective analysis.
The data can be tabulated, plotted on a graph or shown in diagrams and charts.
Circumference Diameter
(cm) (cm)
1 5
2 10
3 15
4 20
When the above data on circumference vs. diameter are plotted, a line graph could
be illustrated as shown below.
30
y (circumference, cm)
25
20
15
10
5
0
1 2 3 4 5
x (diameter, cm)
Study Figure 1 and interpret the data presented. How is the circumference of the can
related to its diameter? What happens to the circumference of the can as the diameter of the
can decreases?
As the diameter of the can increases, the circumference increases and as the
diameter decreases, the circumference decreases also.
22
Figure 5.1 can also be plotted using a bar graph as shown below.
30
y (circumference, cm)
25
20
15
10
5
0
1 2 3 4 5
x (diameter, cm)
There are topics in Science like Water Cycle, Food Web and Rock Cycle that can be
understood better if presented in diagrams and charts.
eagle
Rice plant
Gather information in your Barangay Health Center on the number of patients treated
for several ailments during the last twelve months. Plot the data using a line graph and a bar
graph. Label y-axis as the number of patients treated and x-axis as the number of months.
23
Let’s summarize
1. Observation involves the use of five senses in describing things or events while
inference is making interpretations on the observations or experiences made.
3. Some of the common measuring devices for length are ruler, meter stick, and
yardstick while for mass of objects, the devices include the platform balance, and
triple beam balance.
4. Any measuring device could measure things accurately up to the smallest value or
the least count that this device could give. A ruler for example can measure the
length of an object accurately up to the tenth of a centimeter.
5. The area of an object is determined by getting the product of its two dimensions. For
example, the area of an object, which is rectangular in shape, is length times width (L
x W). The area is always expressed in square units.
6. The Volume of an object is determined by getting the product of its three dimensions.
For example, the volume of any rectangular object is equal to the product of its
length, width and thickness (L x W x T). It is always expressed in cubic units.
7. The conversion factor is the equivalent of one unit in another unit. It is expressed in
fraction form.
8. The Metric System or the SI is the more acceptable system than the English System
because of the convenience it gives in the conversion of one unit to a desired unit.
9. In writing very small or very big numbers using power- of- ten notations, the standard
form used is N = a x 10b.
10. Scientific data could be presented in the form of a graph, a diagram or a chart for
better analysis and interpretation.
24
Posttest
4. If 1/5 would mean there are 5 equal parts in one, how many equal parts are there in
1/8?
a. 5 parts c. 8 parts
b. 6 parts d. 10 parts
7. If 100 centimeters is equal to 1 meter, then how many centimeters are there in 5
meters?
a. 500 cm c. 350 cm
b. 400 cm d. 300 cm
8. The length of the table is 5 m, its width is 3 m and its thickness is 0.1 m. Find its area.
a. 150 m3 c. 1.5 m3
3
b. 15 m d. 0.15 m3
25
9. What is the density of a certain metal whose mass is 30 g and has a volume of 5 cc?
a. 150 g / cc c. 6 g x cc
b. 150 g x cc d. 6 g / cc
10. Rita poured 20 cm3 of water in a graduated cylinder. She dropped a piece of stone
into it. The water level rose to 30 cm3. What is the volume of the stone?
a. 5 cm3 c. 20 cm3
3
b. 10 cm d. 30 cm3
11. Sally is assigned to make 10 pieces of bouquet for her sister’s wedding. If one
bouquet needs 0.2 m of ribbon, how many centimeters of ribbon is she going to buy?
a. 200 cm c. 50 cm
b. 150 cm d. 10 cm
The class of Ms. Fajardo is performing an experiment on the relationship between the
mass and the volume of washers when placed in the graduated cylinder with water. They
used displacement method to determine the volume of the washers. The following data were
obtained:
Mass of 1 washer = 5 g
Volume of 1 washer = 2 cc
Initial volume of graduated cylinder with water = 25 cc
Other related data on the experiment are shown in the table below.
1 5 27
2 10 29
3 15 31
4 20 33
5 25 35
12. If the class adds one more washer in the graduated cylinder making it six, what would
be the total mass of the washers and the volume of water?
a. 30 g 35 cc c. 35 g 37 cc
b. 30 g 37 cc d. 35 g 39 cc
13. What are the variables that are needed to plot the data on a graph?
a. Number of washers and Mass
b. Mass of washers and volume of water
c. Volume and number of washers
d. None of the above
26
14. What is the variable plotted in the X-axis?
a. Number of washers c. Volume of water
b. Mass of washers d. Volume of washers
16. Plot the mass of washer against the volume of water. Describe the Graph line.
y
17. What happens to the volume of water as the mass of water increases?
a. increases c. remains the same
b. decreases d. undetermined
18. Which of the following interpretations best describes the graph line?
a. As the mass increases, the volume decreases
b. As the mass decreases, the volume decreases
c. As the mass increases, the volume remains the same
d. As the volume decreases, the mass remains constant.
19. Give the reason why the Metric System is more acceptable that the English System.
27
Key to Answers
What to do before (Pretest)
1. a 9. a
2. b 10. b
3. d 11. c
4. d 12. a
5. d 13. b
6. c 14. b
7. d 15. c
8. d
Activity 1.1
Observations Inferences
1. A boy wears a coat and tie 1. This boy is the partner of the girl
who wears a gown
2. Two boys dress casually 2. The two boys will not attend the
party
3. On of the girls cries 3. One of the boys quarrels with
this girl
4. One of the boys argues in higher 4. This boy gets mad with his
tones partner
5. The pair who wore formal attire 5. The pair was able to settle the
talks to the boys argument with the pair who
dressed casually
Note for the teacher: Inferences to the observation may vary from one student
to author.
28
Self-Test 1.1
1. Observation
2. Observation
3. Inference
4. Inference
5. Inference
Activity 2.1
Activity 2.2
Self-Test 2.1
1. A = 250 cm2
2. V = 1250 cm3
3. A = 78.50 cm2
4. s = 4 cm
5. 2500 g
29
Activity 3.1
Conversion
Form 1 Form 2
Factor
1 cm = 10 mm 1 cm/10 mm 10 mm/1 cm
1 cg = 10 mg 1 cg/10 mg 10 mg/1 cg
30
Self-Test 4.1
1. 0.75 m x 100 cm = 75 cm
1m
2. 84 m x 1 km = 84 = 0.084 km
1000 m 1000
3. 50 dm x 10 cm = 500 cm
1 dm
4. 20 da x 24 h = 480 h
1 da
5. 5 h x 3600 s = 18000
1h
Self-Test 4.2
1. 5.5 x 10-4
2. 3.5 x 108
3. 7.8 x 10-10
4. 5.075 x 103
5. 4 x 1012
Self-Test 5.1
Note: The teacher is given the option to check students’ responses. Their
answers may vary.
1. a 14. b
2. b 15. c
3. d 16. a straight graph line
4. c 17. a
5. b 18. b
6. b 19. The Metric System is more
7. a acceptable than the English System
8. c because of its convenience in
9. d changing one unit to another.
10. b 20. Observation involves all the basic
11. a sense organs while inference is
12. b making interpretations based on your
13. b past observations or experiences.
31
References
Salmorin, L. M. and Florido, A. (2003), Science and Technology IV. Quezon City: Abiva Publishing House Inc.
See Tho Weng Fong. (1995). Science for secondary schools. Singapore: Longman Singapore Publishers
Tan, M. et al. (2001). TIMSS-LIKE test items in science and mathematics. DOST-SEI, UPNISMED, Pundasyon
Para Sa Mga Guro ng Agham at Matematika, Ink.
Villamil, A. and Sinugbuhan, R. L. (2003). Integrated Science I. Quezon City: ABIVA Publishing House Inc.
32
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 3
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 3
Developing Science Skills and Processes
While the second module focused on exercises to help you sharpen your
mathematical and analytical skills, this module focuses on your manner of solving a
particular problem.
Learning to become a scientist is interesting and exciting. Many scientific skills are
being developed in the process of acquiring science concepts in the classroom, in
performing experiments in the laboratory, and in doing household chores.
Scientists are detectives: they investigate various parts of our universe and gather
many pieces of information. Their goal is to piece all these data together to form theories –
big ideas that can explain whole sets of facts.
This module will bring you to the world of scientists. How do scientists work? How do
they solve problems? In most cases, scientists solve problems by making thorough
investigations. They follow a logical method of solving problems called the scientific method.
This method minimizes the chances of making mistakes. You will study the following
lessons in this module:
After going through the module, you are expected to be able to:
1. identify a problem
2. formulate a hypothesis
3. design a procedure to test the hypothesis
4. collect data and present them in appropriate format
2
5. observe trends and patterns
6. make generalizations and conclusions
7. identify limitations and make recommendations
For Questions 1 – 7, refer to the situation below. Write the letter of the best answer
on the space provided before each item. Each question is worth 1 point.
Using a medicine dropper and water, a student determines the number of water
drops that different sizes of coins can hold. He gathers the data and records them in the
table below
3
.
Number of Water Drops
2. By looking at the data, which coin holds the greatest number of water drops?
a. a 10-peso coin
b. a 5-peso coin
c. a 1-peso coin
d. a 25 centavo coin
3. Which factor do you think has something to do with the differences in the number of
water drops a coin can hold?
a. distance of medicine dropper from the coin
b. sizes of the coins
c. diameter of the dropper
d. all of the above
4. If you want to verify whether the size of the coins affects the number of water drops
that a coin can hold, which of the following hypothesis will you test?
a. The farther the distance of the dropper, the more water drops the coin can
hold.
b. The bigger the diameter of the dropper, the more water drops the coin can
hold
c. The bigger the size of the coin, the more water drops it can hold.
d. The bigger the water drops, the more each coin can hold.
5. Proving the hypothesis “the bigger the size of the coin, the more water drops it can
hold”, which of the following variables will remain unchanged?
a. amount of pressure on the rubber of the medicine dropper
b. distance of the dropper from the coin
c. size of the medicine dropper used
d. size of the coins
4
6. Which of the following can you identify as the responding variable?
a. number of water drops
b. size of the coin
c. diameter of the dropper
d. kind of medicine dropper
When you were a child, what was the thing that you looked for in a playground?
Probably your answer is a set of movable bars or a see-saw. Have you ever wondered how
a see-saw works? Many questions in our minds have now been answered by Science and
Technology. Through Science and Technology, we have been able to produce all comforts
and convenience in life and managed our environment to acquire our needs. We have
improved our ways of communication, transportation, household facilities, recreation and
upgraded our medical equipment.
In the following article taken from Science and Technology I SEDP Series, DECS pp.
3 – 4, you can answer your questions on how these inventions and discoveries have been
made usable.
5
What you will do
Activity 1.1 The story of Thomas Alva Edison
Read the article and answer the self-test given after reading the article.
“Thomas Alva Edison once noticed that when electricity flowed through a piece of
iron wire, the iron wire became red hot. The wire glowed brightly, but not bright enough to
light a room. When he used a thinner piece of iron wire and allowed electricity to pass
through, the wire glowed. But he wanted greater brightness. He tried other metals. Finally
he discovered that a thin piece of tungsten wire could actually glow so bright that it could
light up a room.
But he also saw the glow did not last long. After a few minutes, the wire had burned
to ashes. He wondered why. He knew that oxygen is needed in burning. Using a machine
he pumped out all the air inside the bulb. He enclosed the tungsten wire in what he thought
was already an oxygen-free bulb. He tested the bulb. The bulb glowed longer than before.
What he wanted was a bulb to glow longer and give light steadily, so he continued with his
experiment.
He pumped out all the air or gases inside the tube and test the bulb. He repeated this
steps over and over again getting several bulbs busted in the process. He did not lose hope.
He continued with the experiment until finally the tungsten wire glowed steadily and brighter.
He knew that he succeeded. He invented the incandescent light bulb.
Answer the following questions. Write the letter that corresponds to the right answer before
the number. Check your Answers on page 19.
_____ 1. What was the problem of Thomas Alva Edison in his experiment?
a. Where does electricity come from?
b. What makes an iron glow?
c. How to make a wire glow brighter?
d. How to make a light enough to lit a room using a wire?
6
_____ 2. What was his hypothesis in making the wire glow brighter?
a. The thinner the wire, the brighter will be the bulb.
b. Tungsten wire can produce more brightness than ordinary wire.
c. Tungsten wire can light longer in oxygen-free bulbs.
d. The more oxygen in the bulb, the less glow is produced.
_____ 4. Which of the following methods of solving a problem is applied to Edison’s case?
a. popular method
b. trial and error method
c. serendipity
d. scientific method
_____ 5. What personal trait helped Thomas Edison invent the incandescent bulb?
a. persistence c. patience
b. resourcefulness d. All of these
Read the following situations and answer the questions given to test whether you fully
understood the processes of identifying a problem and formulating hypothesis:
7
2. Mario graduated valedictorian in one of the prestigious public high schools in Manila.
Naturally when he got to college, he was expected to do well and graduate with
honors. But Mario got hooked on network games and surfing the internet. Soon
enough, his grades suffered and he did not do well as expected. What do you think
caused his poor performance in school?
Controlling variables involves the process of deciding which variables or factors will
influence the outcome of an experiment, situation or event and deliberately controlling all
recognized variables in a systematic manner.
Certain methods are used over and over to develop and test scientific ideas. One of
these methods is so basic to all sciences that there can be no science without it. This
method is called observation. This involves obtaining information about objects, situations,
or events using as many senses as possible. Observation may be qualitative or quantitative
in nature. Observing provides both basis for new inferences or hypotheses. Inferring means
8
suggesting more about a set of conditions that is observed. These are based on observed
data and past experience.
These three processes are very important in the work of a scientist and therefore
cannot be omitted in doing an analysis to solve a problem.
A. Go out and look for a place where you can find different kinds of leaves
Observations of Unknowns
9
Guide Questions:
Use the data you gathered during this investigation to help you answer the following
questions:
1. Which of your senses gave the most information about the samples?
_______________________________________________________
2. Which of your senses helped you the most in distinguishing the samples?
_______________________________________________________
3. All your senses have limitations. Name several scientific instruments that help you
overcome the limitations of each of your senses
Sight: ______________________________________________
Touch ______________________________________________
Smell _______________________________________________
Taste _______________________________________________
4. Suppose you waited until you have finished on all five substances before you
recorded the data. What might have happened to the record of your observations?
___________________________________________________
___________________________________________________
___________________________________________________
___________________________________________________
_
5. Is it important that a scientist record his data immediately? Why or why not?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
Record the outdoor temperature on five consecutive mornings. Graph the data
with the temperature on the Y-axis and the date on the x-axis.
10
Date
Can you use the graph to know what will be the temperature in the next 5
days? Why or why not?
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
Plot the data on a graph with the thickness on the Y-axis and the number of
pages on the X-axis
11
Number of pages
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
12
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Can you tell which of the following statements are true? Read each statement. If it is
true, write a T and if it is false, write an F in the blank before the statement. Write in the
blank following the statement how would you change the underlined word or phrase to make
the statement True.
_____ 1. Observation is the act of gathering information using the five senses.
____________
_____ 3. Of all the ways to solve a problem using scientific method, prediction on the basis
of a trend is the most effective and accurate. _________
_____ 4. Inferring means looking for what objects have in common or looking for their
differences. ______________
_____ 6. During experiment, one tries to form a theory as quickly as possible. This process
is called hypothesizing. __________________
_____ 7. Repeating and performing similar experiments can verify a solution to a problem.
_________________
_____ 8. A scientist would most likely find a solution to problem by survey technique.
_____________________
_____10. Little by little you uncover several patterns during an experiment. This process is
called data gathering. ______________
13
Lesson 3 Making Conclusions and Generalizations
One of the most important steps in scientific method is choosing a solution to the
original problem. Unless you consider all available data, you will end up choosing a wrong
one.
3. You are going to heat the aluminum can with an alcohol lamp, but before doing
so, formulate your hypothesis. Write as many as you can. (Be careful in heating
the can. See to it that the flame will not touch the plastic.)
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
14
4. Now heat the can for about 2 minutes. Observe what happens. Record your
observations.
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
6. What conclusion can you make out of the experiment you have performed?
Formulate your conclusion.
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
Answer the following questions and write your answers on the space provided
after each number.
1. The first step of a scientific method is to identify the problem you wish to
solve. What is the problem in this activity?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
2. After you identify the problem, it is time to make observations. What do you
see?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
3. Next the data from your observations must be organized. What factors do
you think play a part in your observations?
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
5. Verify your answer or solution by repeating the experiment if you wish to.
15
What you will do
Activity 3.2
Perform the experiment using the same materials, 5 coins of different sizes – 10-
peso, 5-peso; 1-peso and a 25-centavo coin.
3. Analyze your results. Which coin holds the greatest number of water
drops?
a. a 10-peso coin
b. a 5-peso coin
c. a 1-peso coin
d. a 25 centavo coin
16
4. What factor do you think has something to do with the differences in the
number of water drops a coin can hold?
a. distance of medicine dropper from the coin
b. sizes of the coins
c. diameter of the dropper
d. all of the above
Use the terms from this module (Lessons 1 – 3) to complete the crossword puzzle:
Across
17
Down
1 2
3 4
5 6
9 10
11 12 13
14 15
16
17
18 19
20
21
22
18
Let’s summarize
1. Identifying a problem
2. Formulating a hypothesis
3. Designing a procedure to test the hypothesis
4. Collecting data and presenting them in appropriate format
5. Observing trends and patterns
6. Interpreting data gathered
7. Making generalizations and conclusions
8. Identifying limitations and making recommendations
19
Posttest
A. Multiple Choice. Choose the letter of the correct answer. Write your answers on a
separate sheet.
3. Suppose your mother sent you to the market to buy fruits and vegetables.
How would you choose good quality fruits and vegetables?
a. Ask the vendor to choose it for you.
b. Examine the fruit if it is free from insect bites and the smell of insecticide
c. Just get any kind and pay right away.
d. Tell your mother that you do not know how to buy good quality fruits and
vegetables.
4. When scientists wish to communicate the results of their research, they are most
likely to do which of the following?
a. immediately repeat the research
b. call a press conference
c. write a concise report with complete results and proofs to the experiments
performed and formulate conclusions
d. sell their findings to other researchers
5. During an experiment about a coin and feather that were dropped at the same time, it
was found that the coin reached the ground first. One student said: “Maybe, the coin
is heavier than the feather.” What do you call this kind of statement?
a. a problem
b. a hypothesis
c. an interpretation
d. a conclusion
20
B. Identification. For Numbers 6 – 10, identify what science processes are revealed in
the following statements: Write your answer on the space provided after the number.
6. The girl is standing in an open field. There was no shadow formed because it is
12 noon. ____________________
7. The blue litmus paper turned red when it was dipped into an unknown liquid.
____________________
9. The radio is not functioning anymore. Maybe the battery got discharged.
___________________.
10. The metal turned rusty. What made it that way? ________________
21
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. d 2. b 3. d 4. c 5. c 6. a 7. d
Self-test 1.1
1. d 2. a 3. a 4. b 5. d
Self-Test 2.1
_ T__ 1. Observation is the act of gathering information using the five senses.
__F_ 3. Of all the ways to solve a problem using scientific method, prediction on the
basis of a trend is the most effective and accurate. EXPERIMENTATION
__F__ 4. Looking for what objects have in common, looking for their differences is
called inferring. COMPARING
__T__ 6. During experiment, one tries to form his theory as quickly as possible. This
process is called hypothesizing. __________________
__F__ 8. A scientist would most likely find a solution to problem by survey technique.
SCIENTIFIC METHOD
__T__10. Little by little you uncovered several patterns during an experiment. This
process is called data gathering.
22
Self-Test 3.1 Crossword Puzzle
P1 R E D I2 C T
O3 D4 R N
B A O T5 A B L6 E
S7 O L U T I O N E A
E A F R B
R H8 P O
V9 E R I F Y O 10 R D E R E D
E P E A
P 11 R O V I 12 N T 13 R U T H
R T N O
M 14 O H F T 15 H E O R Y
O B E E Y M 16
D L S R C 17 E
E 18 X P E R I M E N T O L 19 T
L M S N L A H
S C 20 O N C L U S I O N
M 21 E A S U R E E S D
C I I
S 22 C I E N T I F I C
Y A
L
Posttest
A. 1. d 2. b 3. b 4. c 5. b
B. 6. interpretation 7. observation 8. generalization
9. formulating hypothesis 10. identifying a problem
-End of Module-
23
References
Gebelein, C.G. (2001). Chemistry and our world. USA: WCB Wm. C. Brown Publishers
Salmorin, L. M. and Florido, A. (2003). Science and Technology IV. Quezon City: Abiva Publishing House Inc.
Villamil, A. and Sinugbuhan, R. L. (2003). Integrated Science I. Quezon City: ABIVA Publishing House Inc.
24
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 4
1
Module 4
Safety in the Laboratory
The third module provided activities aimed at honing your skills as a budding
scientist. This time, your manner of solving a particular problem will be enhanced because
you will now become a chemist working in a laboratory with different apparatus on hand.
Just read and follow the instructions in this module. Good luck and have fun!
The activities in this module will teach you how to use different apparatus in the
laboratory. This will also enhance your skills in making accurate measurements using
common laboratory equipment and using the equipment properly.
You will now work as a scientist / chemist as you go along this module.
2
How to learn from this module
a. ACID – a substance which can burn the skin and other materials
b. BREAKABLE – characteristic of materials that easily break like glass when
dropped or subjected to pressure
c. CERAMICS – a kind of material that is made of porcelain
d. EVAPORATION – process of changing liquid to gas
e. FLAMMABLE – the ability of a material to burn
f. GLASSWARES – materials that are made of glass like test tubes and
beakers
g. REAGENT – a kind of chemical used in the laboratory
h. VOLATILE – the ability to evaporate easily
i. VOLUME – amount of space occupied by matter
j. TOXIC – poisonous substance
k. RADIOACTIVE – a substance that is not stable and decays spontaneously
l. FUME – a gaseous substance that is emitted by chemicals
m. CORROSIVE – acids and bases that can react with and destroy tissue and
other materials
4. Before working on the activities, answer the 10-item test honestly in order to
determine how much you know the topics in this module.
6. Perform all the activities diligently as these will help you understand the lessons.
8. At the end of the module, take the post-test to measure how much you
understood the lesson.
Good Luck!
3
What to do before (Pretest)
1. Suppose you saw your mother accidentally cut her finger with a broken glass at
home? What will you do?
a. Call a doctor right away
b. Call your neighbors for help.
c. Ignore her and proceed with your playing.
d. Get a medicated plaster and put it around her finger as first aid.
2. While doing an experiment, you happen to come across a bottle with the sign
“SKULL” pasted on it. What does the sign tell you about the content of the
bottle?
a. Its content is edible.
b. Its content is volatile.
c. It contains a dead insect.
d. The chemical inside is poisonous.
3. Given three laboratory apparatuses: beaker, graduated cylinder and test tube.
Which will you use to get the volume of water?
a. beaker
b. test tube
c. graduated cylinder
d. any of the three
4. Your teacher asks you to get the mass of a piece of stone. What apparatus will
you use?
a. graduated cylinder
b. triple beam balance
c. Florence flask
d. Erlenmeyer flask
6. You are asked to boil about 10 mL of water using a test tube. What is the proper
way of holding the test tube when you’re working with somebody in a laboratory?
a. Let the test tube face your partner while it is being heated.
b. Keep the test tube away from anybody else inside the laboratory.
4
c. Hold the test tube directly above the flame.
d. All of the above
7. Which of the following is NOT in the group of apparatus that are used in storing
liquids?
a. Reagent bottle c. Florence flask
b. Beaker d. graduated cylinder
8. Which of these apparatus will you use if you want to measure the density of a
certain liquid?
a. beaker and test tube
b. graduated cylinder and triple beam balance
c. test tube and platform balance
d. beaker and graduated cylinder
9. What will you use to fill a small-mouthed bottle with liquid without spilling?
a. a test tube
b. a funnel
c. a petri dish
d. a graduated cylinder
10. When doing an experiment that uses fire, what should you be ready with?
a. an apron
b. a damp cloth
c. a pail of water
d. a wet tissue paper
Key to answers on page 24
When you think of scientist at work, you probably imagine them in a modern
laboratory with test tubes, other delicate instruments, apparatus, and bottles of strange
substances.
You’re right. In the laboratory, you can find several laboratory apparatus. Perhaps
you are already familiar with some of them through your readings, or from watching
television or the movies or perhaps you have actually used them in your elementary
science.
Let us familiarize ourselves with the different laboratory apparatus and their uses.
5
. What you will do
Activity 1.1 Some Common Laboratory apparatus and their uses
Erlenmeyer flask
Florence Test Tubes Test tube
flask rack
pipette
Graduated cylinder
Erlenmeyer
Medicine dropper flask
burette
Volumetric flask
6
7
8
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
Matching Type: Shown in Column A are the drawings of some common laboratory
apparatus listed. In Column B are the uses of these apparatus. Draw a
line that connects each apparatus with its use.
COLUMN A COLUMN B
APPARATUS USES
9
B. used to clean test tubes or
glassware with narrow opening
2. spring balance
4. graduated cylinder
7. test tube
10
J. used for heating substances
Science is a hands-on laboratory class. You will be doing many laboratory activities
that require the use of different apparatus and hazardous chemicals. Safety in the science
classroom is the number one priority for students and teachers. To ensure a safe science
classroom, a list of rules has been developed and provided for you in this module. These
rules must be followed at all times. The science laboratory is a safe place to work in if you
are careful.
Following are some safety precautions and procedural rules to help you protect
yourself from injury in the laboratory while doing the experiment. Read and understand them
to insure your safety before, during and after doing an experiment.
1. Do not eat food, drink beverages, or chew gum in the laboratory. Do not use laboratory
glassware as containers for food or beverages.
2. Safety goggles and aprons must be worn whenever you work in the lab. Gloves should
be worn whenever you use chemicals that cause skin irritations or when you need to
handle hot equipment.
3. Observe good housekeeping practices. Work areas should be kept clean and tidy at all
times.
11
4. Know the locations and operating procedures of all safety equipment including the first
aid kit, eyewash station, safety shower, spill kit, fire extinguisher, and fire blanket. Know
where the fire alarm and the exits are located.
5. Be alert and proceed with caution at all times in the laboratory. Notify the instructor
immediately of any unsafe conditions you observe.
6. Dispose all chemical waste properly. Never mix chemicals in sink drains. Sinks are to be
used only for water and those solutions designated by the instructor. Solid chemicals,
metals, matches, filter paper, and all other insoluble materials are to be disposed of in
the proper waste containers, not in the sink. Check the label of all waste containers twice
before adding your chemical waste to the container. Cracked or broken glass should be
placed in the special container for “Broken Glass.”
8. Know what to do if there is a fire drill during a laboratory period; containers must be
closed, gas valves turned off, fume hoods turned off, and any electrical equipment turned
off.
9. Keep hands away from your face, eyes, mouth, and body while using chemicals. Wash
your hands with soap and water after performing all experiments. Clean (with detergent
powder), rinse, and dry all work surfaces and equipment at the end of the experiment.
10. If you spill acid or any other corrosive chemical on you skin or clothes immediately wash
the area with large amounts of water (remember that small amounts of water may be
worse that no water at all). After this get the teacher’s attention. The spill kit will be used
for spills on floor or counter-top.
11. At the end of the laboratory session see that: a) the main gas outlet valve is shut off b)
the water is turned off c) the desk top, floor area, and sink are clean d) all equipment
are cool, clean, and arranged properly.
B. Clothing
1. Any time chemicals, heat, or glassware are used, students will wear laboratory goggles.
2. Dress properly during a laboratory activity. Long hair, dangling jewelry, and loose or
baggy clothing are a hazard in the laboratory. Long hair must be tied back and dangling
jewelry and loose or baggy clothing must be secured. Shoes must completely cover the
foot. No sandals are allowed.
1. Report any accident (spill, breakage, etc.) or injury (cut, burn, etc.) to your teacher.
12
2. If a chemical should splash in your eye(s), immediately flush with running water from the
eyewash station for at least 20 minutes. Notify your teacher immediately.
D. Handling Chemicals
1. All chemicals in the laboratory are to be considered dangerous. Do not touch, taste, or
smell any chemical unless specifically instructed to do so. The proper technique for
smelling chemical fumes is to gently fan the air above the chemical toward your face.
Breathe normally.
2. Check the label on chemical bottles twice before removing any of the contents. Take only
as much chemical as you need. Smaller amounts often work better than larger
amounts. Label all containers and massing papers holding dry chemicals.
4. Acids must be handled with extreme care. ALWAYS ADD ACID SLOWLY TO WATER,
with slow stirring and swirling, being careful of the heat produced, particularly with
sulfuric acid.
5. Handle flammable hazardous liquids over a pan to contain spills. Never dispense
flammable liquids anywhere near an open flame or source of heat.
6. Take great care when transferring acids and other chemicals from one part of the
laboratory to another. Hold them securely and in the method demonstrated by the
teacher as you walk.
1. Inserting and removing glass tubing from rubber stoppers can be dangerous. Always
lubricate glassware (tubing, thistle tubes, thermometers, etc.) before attempting to insert
it in a stopper. Always protect your hands with towels or cotton gloves when inserting
glass tubing into, or removing it from, a rubber stopper. If a piece of glassware becomes
"frozen" in a stopper, take it to your instructor for removal.
2. When removing an electrical plug from its socket, grasp the plug, not the electrical cord.
Hands must be completely dry before touching an electrical switch, plug, or outlet.
3. Examine glassware before each use. Never use chipped or cracked glassware. Never
use dirty glassware. Do not immerse hot glassware in cold water; it may shatter.
4. Report damaged electrical equipment immediately. Look for things such as frayed cords,
exposed wires, and loose connections. Do not use damaged electrical equipment.
13
F. Heating Substances
1. SHOULD THE BUNSEN BURNER GO OUT, IMMEDIATELY TURN OFF THE GAS AT
THE GAS OUTLET VALVE. If you wish to turn off the burner, do so by turning off the
gas at the gas outlet valve first, then close the needle valve and barrel. Never reach over
an exposed flame. Light gas burners only as instructed by the teacher.
2. Never leave a lit burner unattended. Never leave anything that is being heated or is
visibly reacting unattended. Always turn the burner or hot plate off when not in use.
3. You will be instructed in the proper method of heating and boiling liquids in test tubes. Do
not point the open end of a test tube being heated at yourself or anyone else.
4. Heated metals, glass, and ceramics remain very hot for a long time. They should be set
aside to cool on a trivet and then picked up with caution. Use tongs or heat-protective
gloves if necessary. Determine if an object is hot by bringing the back of your hand close
to it prior to grasping it.
Look at the scene below. Study and list all the likely causes of accidents.
14
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________
Activity 2.2
Daria is heating some cupric sulfate solution. List the possible dangers in this
scene.
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
15
Activity 2.3
Look at the picture. Write down 3 safety rules that this student should follow.
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________________
16
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Write YES if the statement is a good safety rule in the laboratory and NO, if it is not.
2. Use plastic containers for hot materials even if these are not heat resistant.
____________
3. When heating liquid substances in a test tube, hold it in a slanting position, away
from your body and everyone in the laboratory room. ______________
5. Taste substances in the laboratory room even if you are NOT told to do so.
____________
7. When removing an electrical plug from its socket, grasp the electrical cord. _____
10. When inside the laboratory, NEVER start an experiment unless you are told to do
so. _________
17
Lesson 3 Laboratory Safety Symbols
Before beginning your work in the laboratory, you must become familiar with the
safety symbols used. The idea of using symbols is to transmit information regarding your
safety inside the laboratory clearly and easily. The safety symbols that will be presented in
this module are the most familiar ones. These symbols are accompanied by explanations.
Chemicals,
broken glass,
Special living Dispose of
DISPOSAL disposal organisms wastes as
considerations such as directed by your
required bacterial teacher
cultures,
protests, etc.
Avoid skin
Organisms or Bacteria, contact with
organic fungus, blood, organisms or
BIOLOGICAL materials that raw organs, material. Wear
can harm plant material dust mask or
humans gloves, Wash
hands thoroughly
Use proper
protection when
Boiling liquids, handling.
EXTREME Objects that hot plates, Remove
TEMPERATURE can burn skin liquid flammables from
by being too nitrogen, dry the area around
cold or too hot ice, all open flames or
burners spark sources
Use of tools or Razor blade, Practice common
glassware that scalpel, awl, sense behavior
SHARP OBJECT can easily nails, push and follow
puncture or pins, etc. guidelines for
slice skin use of the tool
18
Potential danger Ammonia, Make sure
to olfactory tract heating sulfur, there is good
from fumes moth balls, nail ventilation and
FUME polish remover, never smell
acetone, any fumes directly
volatile
substances
Double-check
Possible danger Improper setup with
ELECTRICAL from electrical grounding, liquid instructor.
shock or burn spills, short Check
circuits condition of
wires and
apparatus
Substances Acid such as
(acids and vinegar,
bases) that can hydrochloric
react with and acid, hydrogen Wear goggles
CORROSIVE destroy tissue peroxide, and an apron
and other sodium
materials hydroxide, soap
19
Always wash
your hands
HYGIENE after
completing an
experiment.
1. ______________ 2. _____________
3. ______________ 4. _______________
5. ___________________6. _________________
7. _______________ 8. __________________
20
9. __________________ 10. ___________________
Let’s summarize
A. Laboratory Precautions
1. Do not eat food, drink beverages, or chew gum in the laboratory. Do not
use laboratory glassware as containers for food or beverages.
2. Wear safety goggles and aprons
3. Always keep the working area clean and orderly.
4. Know the locations and operating procedures of all safety equipment.
5. Be alert and proceed with caution at all times in the laboratory. Notify the
instructor immediately of any unsafe conditions you observe.
Handling Chemicals
21
Handling Glassware and Equipment
Heating Substances
1. TURN OFF THE GAS AT THE GAS OUTLET VALVE after using.
2. Never leave a lit burner unattended. Never leave anything that is being
heated or is visibly reacting unattended.
3. Use tongs or heat-protective gloves when holding or touching heated
apparatus.
B. Warning Signs
FUME
DISPOSAL
HYGIENE
BIOLOGICAL ELECTRICAL
EXTREME CORROSIVE
TEMPERATURE
FLAMMABLE RADIOACTIVE
22
Posttest
1. When doing an experiment like heating or anything that uses fire, what should you
be ready with?
a. an apron
b. a damp cloth
c. a pail of water
d. a wet tissue paper
2. Acids must be handled with extreme care. In diluting an acid, what should you do?
a. Do it in anyway you want.
b. Always add acid slowly to water
c. Always add the water to the acid.
d. Mix the acid to the water by stirring
4. You are asked by your teacher to clean the test tube. What should you use?
a. graduated cylinder
b. triple beam balance
c. test tube brush
d. crucible tong
5. You have come across this icon pasted on a bottle. What does this mean?
a. It is poisonous
b. It is radioactive
c. It is a metal
d. It is a non-metal
6. While inside the hospital’s laboratory area, you saw this icon in one of the rooms.
What does this mean?
a. The room is strictly for nurses.
b. The room is only for technician.
c. The room is used for X-ray purposes.
d. The room is used for storage of hazardous chemicals.
7. You are asked to measure the density of liquid. Density is defined as mass over
volume. Which of the following apparatus will you use?
I. beaker II. graduated cylinder
III triple beam balance IV. test tube
23
a. I and II only b. II and III only
c. III and IV only d. I, II, III, and IV
9. What will you use to transfer liquid to another bottle without spilling?
a. a funnel
b. a test tube
c. a petri dish
d. a graduated cylinder
10. Which of the following apparatus does NOT belong to the group?
a. volumetric flask
b. reagent bottles
c. test tube
d. beaker
24
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. b 2. d 3. b 4. b 5. b
6. b 7. d 8. b 9. b 10. b
Self-Test 1.1
1. I 2. E 3. J 4. C 5. D
6. G 7. F 8. B 9. H 10. A
Self-Test 2.1
1. The position of the test tube while heating is towards the students.
2. The student doing the experiment is not wearing gloves.
3. The hair of the student doing the experiment is not tied properly.
4. Observers are too close to the test tube.
5. Copper sulfate should not be heated directly. Wire gauze is necessary.
25
Possible Answers for Activity 2.3
1. Long hair, dangling jewelry, and loose or baggy clothing are a hazard in the
laboratory. Long hair must be tied back and dangling jewelry and loose or baggy
clothing must be secured.
2. Safety goggles and aprons must be worn whenever you work in the lab. Gloves
should be worn whenever you use chemicals that cause skin irritations or when you
need to handle hot equipment.
3. Keep hands away from your face, eyes, mouth, and body while using chemicals.
Wash your hands with soap and water after performing all experiments. Clean (with
detergent powder), rinse, and dry all work surfaces and equipment at the end of the
experiment.
4. Handle flammable hazardous liquids over a pan to contain spills. Never dispense
flammable liquids anywhere near an open flame or source of heat.
Self-Test 3.1
1. TOXIC
2. FLAMMABLE
3. RADIOACTIVE
4. HARMFUL OR IRRIRANT
5. OXIDIZING AGENT
6. CORROSIVE
7. PROPER DISPOSAL
8. HYGIENE
9. ELECTRICAL
10. GLOVES
Posttest
1. b 2. b 3. a 4. c 5. a
6. c 7. b 8. a 9. a 10. c
-End of Module-
References:
Gebelein, Charles G. (2001). Chemistry and our World. USA: WCB Wm. C. Brown Publishers
Lemay, E , Robblee, K, and Beall, H, Chenistry: Connections to our changing world : Prentice Hall
26
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 5
1
Module 5
Matter Around Me
Have you been to the sari-sari store lately? Did you notice the different items that you
can buy from the store? Can you name some of them? Yes, there are candies, canned
goods, softdrinks, wine, eggs, tissue paper, toothbrush, diapers, toothpaste, shampoo and
many more. In science, we call all these items as MATTER.
Do you know that there are a lot of things that you can learn about matter? In fact,
this module is designed to help you in defining matter and in classifying different kinds of
matter. It also aims to guide you in determining the changes that matter undergoes and in
identifying its characteristics. So, don’t miss this rare opportunity – read and have fun in
learning the following lessons:
1. define matter;
2. cite examples of matter;
3. classify matter as solid, liquid or gas based on its observable characteristics;
4. differentiate substance from mixture and give examples of each;
5. classify substances as element or compound;
6. differentiate between metal and non-metal based on their observable
properties;
7. describe physical and chemical changes;
8. identify evidences of chemical change;
9. give examples of physical and chemical changes in daily life; and
10. infer that energy is involved in physical and chemical changes.
2
How to learn from this module
I know that you are already excited to get started, however, there are some tips that
you have to remember
Take the pre-test before proceeding to the lessons. The test could give you an
idea of how much time should you allot to each lesson.
Read the instructions carefully and follow the precautionary measures.
Before doing the activity, make sure that all the materials needed are already
prepared.
Perform the simple activities before reading the discussions.
Don’t forget to answer the Self-Tests. Compare your answers with the keys to
correction.
If you are not sure of the meaning of some words used in this module, feel free
to consult the dictionary.
Answer the post-test so that you will know how much you have learned from
the lessons.
Happy Reading!
Choose the best answer and write the letter of your choice on the space provided
before each number.
_____2. Of the phases of matter, which has the strongest attractive forces?
A. solid
B. liquid
C. gas
D. all of the above
3
_____3. Galvanized iron, which is commonly used for roofing, is made up mostly of
iron metal. Which of the characteristics of metal makes it an appropriate
roofing material?
A. It is shiny.
B. It has high density.
C. It can be hammered into sheets.
D. It can be drawn into fine wire.
_____7. Using the table below, which materials do you expect to sink in water?
4
_____9. Rusting of iron is a chemical change. All phase changes are physical
changes.
A. Both statements are true.
B. Both statements are false.
C. The first statement is true while the second is false.
D. The second statement is true while the first is false.
_____10. Jeff placed some mothballs inside the cabinet. After some days, the
mothballs disappeared. What happened to the mothballs?
A. It sublimed.
A. It evaporated.
B. It reacted with air inside the cabinet.
C. It was dissolved by water present in air.
If your score is
9-10 Very Good! You may still read the module but you are already knowledgeable
with the topics that we are to discuss.
7-8 Good! Go over the items that you find difficult and then you may proceed to
the lessons in this module that you don’t understand.
0-5 Don’t worry about your score. This module is designed for you to understand
all about matter. So, what are you waiting for? Start your journey. Turn to the
next page.
5
Lesson 1 What is Matter?
Look around you. What are the things that you see? Below are some items that could
be in your surroundings at the moment. I want you to go over the list and encircle the items
that are around you.
THINGS AROUND ME
You are right! The table is the heaviest of the three objects while the paper seemed
to be the lightest. On the other hand, the plate may not be as heavy as the table but it is not
as light as the paper. What does these indicate? It means that objects or things around us
may be light or heavy which could simply mean that these things have mass.
6
Now, using your paper and pencil, trace the paper. Trace also the notebook and
the plate. Take a closer look at the drawings.
What have you noticed? Does each one occupy space? You are
right! Objects occupy space. In science, space occupied is referred to as
volume.
Can you trace the table? Perhaps not. It would be difficult to trace the table because
it is too big. How are we going to show then that the table also occupies space?
Go to where the table is. Can you stand on the space where the
table is located?
Of course not. Why? You simply cannot take the position of the table because the
table occupies space and so are you. It would be just like sitting on a chair where another
person is seated.
Materials that occupy space and have mass are regarded as MATTER. The flower,
plate, notebook and all the other objects/things in the “THINGS AROUND ME” are examples
of matter. Can you cite other examples of matter?
7
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
Since you are now familiar with what matter is, list at least 15 other examples of
matter.
Examples of Matter
1. 11.
2. 12.
3. 13.
4. 14.
5. 15.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
As what we have learned in Lesson 1, matter is anything that has mass and occupies
space. From this description, we could say that all the stuff in the universe are considered
as examples of matter. As such, dealing with matter would mean dealing with enormous
materials.
Due to the wide variety of examples of matter, scientists recognized the need to
classify them. How is matter classified? To give you an idea on how samples of matter are
grouped together, why don’t you do Activity 2.1?
8
What you will do
Activity 2.1
If you were working in a supermarket, which of the following items would you place in
the same shelf?
How did you group the materials? Check if your groupings are the same as mine.
What is your basis in grouping the given materials? Materials with the same
characteristics should be grouped together. In the same way, the numerous samples of
matter are classified based on properties similar to them.
Matter can be classified according to its phases namely: solid, liquid and gas. A chair
and a plate are solids while water and soy sauce are liquids. On the other hand, air inside
the balloon is an example of gas.
9
Let us analyze the properties of each phase of matter.
What did you notice? Water and soy sauce take the shapes of their containers. Thus,
we can say that the shape of the liquid is dependent on the shape of the container.
Thus, we could say that solids have definite shape while liquids and gases have no
definite shape since they just take the shape of their containers. The table below further
differentiates the three phases of matter in terms of their other characteristics.
To further help you imagine how the particles of the different phases are arranged, let
us do Activity 2.2.
10
What you will do
Activity 2.2
What to do:
1. Fill the match box with corn kernels. Shake the box.
2. Empty the box. Then put 20 corn kernels in it. Shake the box.
3. This time, just place 3 corn kernels in the box and then shake.
What conclusion can you make from the results of Activity 2.2. Right! The
characteristics of the phases of matter can be explained by the arrangement of their
particles.
11
What you will do
Self-Test 2.2
2. How will you explain the differences in the motion of particles of the phases of
matter?
3. Can you describe why solids and liquids have high densities while gases have low
densities?
Matter
can be
classified into
Substances Mixtures
12
Based on the diagram, matter can be classified into substances and mixtures. Water,
salt, sugar and iron nail are some examples of substances. Whereas, sugar solution, salt
solution, halu-halo and mayonnaise are examples of mixtures. Using these examples, how
can we differentiate substances from mixtures? To help you answer this question, let us
proceed to Activity 3.1.
Reminder: Please read the procedure carefully before starting with the activity.
Don’t forget to answer the guide questions.
Materials Needed: water, table salt, two glasses, spoon and casserole
What to do:
1. Pour water into the glasses.
2. Label the glasses as glass A and glass B.
3. Put a pinch of salt in glass A and then stir.
4. Put one tablespoon of salt in glass B.
Compare the appearance of glass A and glass B. Are their appearance the same?
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
5. Pour the contents of glass A into the casserole and then heat. Continue
heating until the mixture dries up. Observe.
If you are going to heat the contents of glass B, will you be able to recover the same
substance that you have recovered from glass A? Can you name the substance?
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
13
6. Clean the casserole, then put a little amount of water in it. Heat the water.
Observe.
Guide Question: What do you think is happening to water while you are heating it?
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
Let us discuss what you have discovered in Activity 3.1. Upon mixing salt and water
through stirring, can you still see the particles of salt? If not anymore, why not? The salt
dissolves in water. Therefore, the water that is originally in the glass is no longer pure water
but is already a physical combination of salt and water, which is called salt solution.
Characteristics of Mixtures
Is the mixture in glass B also a salt solution? Yes, it is a salt solution as well. Notice
that even if glass B contains more salt than glass A, the appearance of both mixtures is the
same. What does this mean? It means that the components (in this case, salt and water) of
mixture can be present in any amount or in any proportion.
Let us now move on to the other parts of the activity. What happens to the salt
solution as it is being heated? After sometime, the mixture starts to dry up. Eventually, the
liquid component of the mixture disappears and what is left in the casserole is a powdery
white substance.
Can you name the white substance that is left in the casserole? Your guess is as
good as mine. Yes, it is the table salt. So, what did you manage to do with the salt solution
when you exposed it to heat? You have actually separated the components of salt solution.
The liquid component, which is water, undergoes the process of evaporation. What is
evaporation? It is a change in the phase of matter from liquid to gas. Such change in phase
can only happen if energy (just like heat!) is involved.
14
From the discussion, what are the important characteristics of mixture that you have
learned?
Third, since a
mixture is just a physical
Fourth, the properties of the combination of two or
components of mixture are more substances then it
retained in the mixture. To follows that it can as well
explain this further, why is the be separated by ordinary
color of salt solution colorless? physical processes e.g.
It is because the water is evaporation.
colorless. Why is it that the salt
solution is salty? It is because
of the salt. Thus, this would
mean that the characteristics of
the components of the mixture
are retained in the mixture.
Do you know that a more suitable physical process is being used in separating the
components of salt solution? To find out more about the physical processes being used in
separating components of mixtures, check out your school library. Read, learn and have
fun!
15
Substances: Element or Compound?
What about elements? Can elements be broken down into simpler substances? I am
so sorry to disappoint you but elements cannot be separated by physical or even by
chemical processes. Why? Because element is the simplest form of matter!
Below is the periodic table of elements. As you can see the elements are arranged
according to increasing atomic number. To date, there are already 116 elements. Seventy-
five percent of the elements are metals while the rest are nonmetals and metalloids.
16
metals and nonmetals.
What are the characteristics of metals that can be used to differentiate them from
nonmetals? Iron nail is a metal while activated carbon (charcoal) is a nonmetal. Obviously of
the two, iron will be a better conductor of electricity than charcoal. Whereas, charcoal is
brittle which is in contrast to the hardness of metals.
Now, examine your incandescent lamp. What can you see at the center of the bulb?
There is what we call a filament. Do you know that the filament is a metal? Notice that the
filament is a very thin wire. Why is this so? Because metals are ductile. Ductility is the
ability of metals to be drawn into wire. Aside from that, metals are malleable. Malleability is
the ability to be hammered into sheets without breaking.
Generally, metals are in the solid phase (with the exception of Mercury, which is the
only metal in the liquid phase) thus we could expect metals to have high densities. It should
be remembered though that different substances have different densities. And that density
can be used as one of the bases in determining a certain substance since this property is
inherent in the substance. Below are the densities of some common metals.
Notice that the densities of the metals are higher than 1.00 g/mL, which is the density
of water at standard conditions. Will you expect the metals to float or sink in water? You are
right! The metals (those listed above) will sink in water!
17
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
Many changes are happening around us. These changes may either be physical
or chemical. Physical changes are changes in matter that are characterized by changes in
size, shape, physical appearance or phase. To know more about this type of change, let us
perform Activity 4.1. The activity takes a closer look at some common physical changes in
our environment
18
What you will do
Activity 4.1
A. Crumple the old newspaper and then cut it into small pieces.
Is the crumpled paper still the old newspaper? ______________________
Did you change the composition of the newspaper when you cut it into pieces?
____________________________________________________
C. Put some ice in a clean glass. Examine it every 3 minutes for half an hour.
Describe what happens to the ice. __________________________________
Let us discuss your observations in Activity 4.1. As what you have noticed, the
following changes have happened in the different parts of the activity: (A) There was a
change in the size and shape of the old newspaper. (B) There was a change in the size and
shape of the clay. (C) There was a change in the phase of matter. From solid, it turned into
liquid. (D) There was change in the phase of salt. From solid, it turned to liquid. Thus, the
observations suggest that changes in matter described in Activity 4.1 are all physical
changes.
Remember also that all phase changes are just physical changes. It therefore
follows that the processes of evaporation, condensation, melting, sublimation, freezing and
deposition are just physical changes.
19
What you will do
Activity 4.1
Materials Needed: vinegar, baking soda, match, piece of paper (a small one!), glass, spoon
A. Half fill the glass with vinegar. Then, place one tablespoon of baking soda. Observe
what happens.
Describe what happens when vinegar was mixed with baking soda.
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________________
B. Note: Please do this outside your house and in an open space. Kindly burn the small
piece of paper.
Let us discuss the results of the activity. In Part A, vinegar did not dissolve the
baking soda. There was actually a chemical change that happened between the two that
resulted to the formation of some new substances. One of the substances is carbon dioxide
gas. Notice that the composition of carbon dioxide is not the same as vinegar and baking
soda. This indicates that the change resulted to a change in the composition and as such, it
could be identified as a chemical change.
How do we know that carbon dioxide is produced? Did you observe the formation
of bubbles? The bubbles indicate that a gas is being evolved. Evolution of gas is one of the
signs or evidences of a chemical change.
Part B involves burning of paper. Notice that after burning, you no longer have the
paper. What you have are ashes! Is the composition of ashes the same as paper? No, they
are not the same! Thus, burning of paper is a chemical change.
Other evidences of chemical change include production of heat and light and
these are observed in the burning of paper.
20
What you will do
Self-Test 4.1
Self-Test 4.2
1. Cite at least five examples of chemical changes that are happening around us.
2. Name five examples of physical change that are part of our daily life.
The changes in matter that we have discussed will not actually happen if energy
in not involved. For instance, evaporation of water will not occur unless heat is involved!
Self-Test 4.3
Can you think of any change in matter that does not involve energy?
21
Let’s summarize
I hope you had a great time reading this module. More importantly, I also hope
that you have learned key concepts regarding matter. And to help you remember the
concepts that we have discussed, I have summarized them for you.
3. Matter can be classified according to phases namely: solid, liquid and gas.
4. The table below differentiates the phases of matter in terms of some general
characteristics.
Matter
can be classified
Substances Mixtures
22
6. Mixture is a physical combination of two or more substances while compound is a
chemical combination or two or more elements.
8. Element is the simplest form of matter since it cannot be separated into simpler
substances.
10. Drying of clothes, melting of ice cream, boiling of water and sublimation of
mothballs are some of the many examples of physical changes that are
happening around us.
12. Formation of bubbles, formation of precipitate and production of heat and light are
some of the evidences of chemical change.
13. Rusting of iron, tarnishing of silver utensils, souring of milk and spoilage of food
are some of the many examples of chemical changes that are happening around
us.
14. Changes in matter will not actually happen if energy is not involved. For instance,
evaporation of water will not occur unless heat is involved!
23
Posttest
Direction: Choose the letter that best answers the question or completes the
statement.
_____2. Of the phases of matter, which has the weakest attractive forces?
A. Solid C. Gas
B. Liquid D, None of the above
_____4. Rubbing alcohol is a mixture. Which of the following best describes the components
of rubbing alcohol?
A. They are chemically combined.
B. They are present in definite proportion.
C. They combine in a fixed ratio by mass.
D. They can be separated by physical means.
_____7. Using the table below, which materials do you expect to float in water?
24
A. concrete, cork, ice
B. iron, ice, aluminum
B. gasoline, cork, ice
D. concrete, mercury, aluminum
25
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. A
2. A
3. C
4. B
5. A
6. A
7. D
8. B
9. A
10. A
Self-Test 1.1
Activity 2.2
Self-Test 2.2
1.
(a) solid
(b) gas
(c) solid
(d) liquid
(e) liquid
26
2. The difference in the motion of particles of the phases of matter could be best explained
by the arrangement of their particles.
3. Density can be calculated by dividing mass over volume. If the particles of solid, liquid
and gas are to occupy the same space, it could be expected that the number of particles
in the solid phase are greater as compared to the number of particles in the liquid and
gaseous phase. Given such situation, it could be inferred that the mass of solid is greater
than that of the two other phases. And since the volume is the same for the three
phases, then it could be expected that the quotient of the mass over volume is greatest
in solid and least in gases. Therefore, the densities of solids are higher than liquids and
gases.
Self-Test 3.1
1.
a. pure substance
b. mixture
c. mixture
d. mixture
e. mixture
2.
a. metal
b. non-metal
c. metalloid
d. metal
e. non-metal
4.
Characteristics of Metals Characteristics of Non-
metals
They are malleable. They are soft and brittle.
They are ductile. They are not malleable.
They possess luster. They are not ductile.
They are good conductors of They are good insulators.
electricity.
27
Self-Test 4.1
i.A
ii.A
iii.B
iv.A
v.B
Self-Test 4.2
1. Answers may vary. Probable answers are: ripening of mango, rusting of iron,
souring of milk, tarnishing of silver utensils, cooking of meat.
2. Answers may vary. Probable answers are: mixing of the ingredients in baking a
cake, dissolving sugar in water, melting of ice, evaporation of water, sublimation of
mothballs
Self-Test 4.3
Post-test
1. C
2. C
3. D
4. D
5. A
6. B
7. C
8. D
9. A
10. B
-End of Module-
References
Apostol, J.A. et.al. (2000). Worktext in Physical Science. Quezon City: Milson’s Publishing.
Chang, R. (2005). Chemistry. New York :McGraw Hill.
Gebelein, C. G. (2001) Chemistry and our world. USA: WCB Wm. C. Brown Publishers
28
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 6
1
Module 6
Behavior of Matter
You have learned how to classify matter in terms of the properties common to them.
These properties are those that can be observed by our senses. Have you ever wondered
how these properties came about and what matter is made of?
This module presents activities that lead to your understanding of the structure of
matter and the behavior of the particles of matter describing the chemical reactions of
substances in our environment.
As you study the structure of matter, the simplest question you must ask is “What is
matter?” You have already learned that matter occupies space and has mass. In this
module, you will investigate more deeply into matter, take it apart and find out what it is
made of.
2
How to learn from this module
Direction: Fill in the blank/s to complete the statements. Choose your answer on the
list of words below.
Key Terms:
1. Scientists call a group of symbols and numbers that stands for a compound a/an
______________.
3
3. Matter that is made up of only one kind of atom is a/an ______________.
6. A tiny particle that travels around the nucleus is called the __________.
8. _________ are elements that have luster and are good conductors of electricity.
9. A charged atom is a/an __________.
10. A bond in which electrons are shared between two atoms is a/an ___________ bond.
12. A property of matter that retains its identity after a reaction is called ___________.
13. ___________ are formed when two or more atoms join together.
20. _______________ are the electrons on its farthest or outermost electron shell.
4
Lesson 1 Structure of Matter
Atomic Structure
This lesson tackles the structure of matter. Matter is composed of tiny particles
called atom. An atom is the smallest particle of an element. Atoms of different elements
may also combine into systems called molecules, which are the smallest units of chemical
compounds. These are also considered as the ultimate building blocks of matter.
But what are atoms made of? What makes one type of atom different from another?
A careful study of the atom shows that it has a small but dense core called the nucleus.
The nucleus is composed of protons the positively charged particle and the neutrons, the
particle with no charge. Around the nucleus is the electron, the negatively charged particle.
proton electron
nucleus
neutron
shells
Scientists agree on the idea of an atom having these particles – the protons and the
neutrons in the nucleus and the electrons around the nucleus. However, they represent the
atomic models differently as shown by the diagrams:
5
BOHR MODEL RUTHERFORD MODEL THOMSON MODEL
The studies by Rutherford and other scientists showed both the neutron and the
proton have a mass that is 1,800 times larger than the electrons. This explains why most of
the mass of an atom is concentrated in the nucleus.
The total number of protons in a given atom determines the atomic number of an
element. The atomic number is the number of protons (positively charged elementary
particles) in the nucleus of one of its atoms. If the atom is electrically neutral, the same
number of electrons is present, since the number of protons is equal to the number of
electrons. The atomic mass or mass number is the sum of an atom's protons and neutrons
that are always expressed in whole numbers. Atomic number is the subscript to the left and
the atomic mass is the superscript to the right of a chemical symbol of an element found in
the Periodic Table of Elements. For example, 6C12 indicates a carbon atom of atomic mass
12 and atomic number 6, the difference being equal to the number of neutrons in the
nucleus. This means for 6C12, there are 6 protons and 6 neutrons, and it follows that it has 6
electrons, too. (In other presentations of The Modern Periodic Table, the superscript is the
atomic number and the subscript is the atomic mass. The atomic number is always less than
the atomic mass)
A
ZE
Mass
number
Atomic
number ELEMENT
In most nuclei, the number of neutrons is equal to or slightly greater than the number
of protons. As the elements get more massive, they tend to have an excess number of
neutrons. For example, the nucleus of uranium, the heaviest natural element, has 146
neutrons and 92 protons (92U238).
6
Molecules and Chemical Bonds
Sometimes the atoms of an element are found alone. At other times they are found
joined together. When two or more atoms combine, whether these are the same or different,
they form a molecule. If these two or more molecules are fitted to combine, a chemical
bond is formed.
There are three types of chemical bonds: ionic bond, covalent bond and metallic
bond.
An ionic bond is formed when one atom shifts or transfers an electron to another
atom. This happens commonly when atoms with one valence electron, the alkali metals,
elements in Group IA are combined with seven valence electrons, the halogens or elements
belonging to Group VIIA. A good example is table salt. When sodium (Na+) reacts with
chlorine (Cl-), they form the molecule sodium chloride (table salt), which is written as NaCl.
Elements in Group IIA may combine with elements in Group VIA. In general, atoms will
form chemical bonds if the bonding will cause all atoms involved to have a stable outer
electron shell or eight electrons. This rule is called the OCTET RULE. It states that atoms
are in stable condition when the outermost electron shell has eight electrons.
Sometimes atoms form bonds in which they share electrons. This is called covalent
bond. Water (H2O) is an example of covalent bond. Two electrons, one from each atom of
hydrogen, is shared with one atom of oxygen, since oxygen needs two more electrons for it
to become stable. Another example is carbon dioxide,(CO2). Carbon from Group IVA has
four valence electrons. It can complete its outer shell by sharing two pairs of electrons with
one oxygen atom and two pairs with another one.
The last type is the metallic bond. While in ionic and covalent bonds, a metal
combines with a non-metal, in metallic bond, a metal shares electrons with another metal.
7
What you will do
Activity 1.1
How did you determine the number of protons, number of electrons and the number
of neutrons?
8
Complete the table below. Refer to Table of Compounds and their Molecular formula
for your answer: The first two (2) numbers were done for you.
Direction: Match the term in column A to the phrase that describes it in Column B. Write
the letter of your answer on the space provided before each term.
COLUMN A COLUMN B
___________ 1. compound a. number of protons and neutrons in the
nucleus
___________ 2. nucleus b. positively charged particles in the nucleus
___________ 3. neutron c. small but dense core of the atom
___________ 4. proton d. negatively charged particle outside the
nucleus of an atom
___________ 5. shells e. energy states in which the electrons of an
atom can exist
___________ 6. molecules f. combination of two or more elements
___________ 7. ionic bond g. used to represent a compound
___________ 8. metallic bond h. particle in the nucleus with no charge
___________ 9. covalent bond i. number of protons in the nucleus
___________ 10. chemical j. element having the same atomic number but
formula different atomic mass
9
___________ 11. atomic number k. this is formed when atoms combine
___________ 12. isotopes l. states that eight electrons are needed to attain
stability
___________ 13. electron m. involves a shift or transfer of electron from
one atom to another atom
___________ 14. atomic mass n. involves a sharing of electrons in metals to
another metal
___________ 15. octet rule o. involves a sharing of electron in different
kinds of atoms
This lesson discusses the molecular theory of matter. The assumption that
molecules are constantly moving is called the kinetic molecular theory of matter. That
matter exerts force on another matter is an evidence of molecular force.
The following are some of the evidences that support the molecular theory:
Perform the following activities and answer the question after each procedure.
This evidence is called diffusion. The molecules of alcohol mix with the molecules
of the air, and since the air is constantly moving, the smell spread throughout.
10
Cite other examples:
___________________________________________________________
___________________________________________________________
2. Pour a few drops of water in a saucer. Cut a piece of tissue paper into strips. Put
one end of the strip of tissue paper into the water. Observe.
___________________________________________________________
This shows the ability of matter to rise on a fine or hair-like tube. This is called
Capillarity. Since the tissue paper has these hair-like structures on its surface, the
water clings to it and rises. Also, the tissue is absorbent. Adhesion is also evident.
The molecules of water adhere to the molecules of the tissue. Adhesion is the
attraction between unlike molecules.
3. Using a medicine dropper, put about two drops of water on top of a glossy or shiny
table. Observe. Describe the shape of the water drops.
___________________________________________________________
This shows that molecules of matter are cohesive. Cohesion is the force of
attraction between molecules that are alike.
4. Add a drop of liquid soap on a basin with water. Observe. Touch it using your finger.
What did you observe?
___________________________________________________________
This is what we call surface tension. It is the ability of matter to form a temporary
membrane. In this case, cohesive force is less than adhesive force.
11
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
12
Lesson 3 Symbols and Chemical Formulas
This next lesson will teach you how to read symbols of elements from the Periodic
Table and how to write chemical formula given the names of the compounds.
For many years, scientists particularly chemists have developed a unique system of
symbols and notation designed to simplify the writing of chemical symbols, formula, and
reactions. This system also shows the mathematical relations of atoms and reacting
chemicals, the way atoms are put together to form complex molecules, and the type of
chemical bond between atoms.
The early alchemists used various symbols to represent the 92 natural elements they
used, a custom that was continued into the 19th century. Johann Jacob Berzelius of
Sweden was the first to use letters to represent the elements. In most cases he was able to
use the first letter of the name of the element as its symbol; O stood for oxygen, C for
carbon, H for hydrogen, and so on. Two letters are used to distinguish between elements
that have the same initial letter N for nitrogen, Ne for neon, and Ni for nickel. Sometimes
the symbol is derived from the Latin name of the element; gold (aurum) is Au, iron
(ferrum) is Fe, and lead (plumbum) is Pb. Whenever two letters are used for an element,
the first letter is capitalized but the second is not. Thus the element cobalt, Co, is
distinguished from the compound carbon monoxide, CO.
Due to the continued search for synthetic elements, aside from the 92 naturally -
occurring elements, scientists found man-made elements and they devised another way of
representing these elements in symbols. Some man-made elements are written in the table
below:
13
These elements are organized in a table of elements called the periodic table. It is a
classification and tabulation of the chemical elements in the order of their atomic numbers
that shows elements' chemical and physical properties.
In this periodic table, the numbers on the left superscript is the atomic
number of the element
14
Compound and Its Chemical Formula
Certain combinations of atoms form stable groups called radicals or polyatomic ion,
which form chemical bonds as an intact unit. The valence number of these radicals is taken
as one. If a molecule contains more than one of a given radical, its written formula
emphasizes this by using parentheses. Calcium phosphate, a major constituent of bones
and teeth, is written Ca3(PO4)2.
1. Write the correct symbols of the elements and the polyatomic ions.
2. Determine the charge or valence number of the elements and the ions.
3. Indicate the charge by writing it on the right superscript
4. Exchange their valence numbers using the CRISS-CROSS METHOD.
a. Lithium oxide
1+ 2-
Li O = Li2O
15
b. Magnesium chloride
2+ 1-
Mg Cl = MgCl2
c. Calcium oxide:
2+ 2-
Ca O = CaO
(if the valence numbers are the same, no need to write them as subscript)
d. Calcium phosphate
2+ 3-
Ca (PO4) = Ca3(PO4)2
e. Hydrogen sulfate
1+ 2-
H (SO4) = H2SO4
16
What you will do
Self-test 3.1
This lesson will help you understand the different types of chemical reactions and
transform these reactions into equations. In a chemical reaction, the substances that
combine are called reactants, while the substance/s produced is/are called product/s. An
arrow is used to represent a yield. Activation energy is needed to start up a chemical
reaction. In order to speed up this reaction a catalyst is used.
17
A chemical equation is used to represent a chemical reaction.
A+B AB
The law of conservation of mass is applied in writing a chemical equation. This law
states that a new atom cannot be created in a chemical reaction and that the mass of the
reactants is equal to the mass of the products.
REACTANTS PRODUCTS
There are four (4) general types of chemical reaction. Study the presentation:
Ex. Na + Cl NaCl
18
3. Single displacement – one element in the reactants replaces one of the elements
in the given compound. The products are still one element and a compound.
AB + C A + BC or AB + C B + AC
AB + CD AC + BD or AB + CD AD + BC
19
What you will do
Self-Test 4.1
2. HgO Hg + O2 ______________________
Let’s summarize
1. An atom is the smallest particle of an element. Atoms of different elements may also
combine into systems called molecules.
2. An atom has a small but dense core called the nucleus. The nucleus is composed of
protons, the positively charged particle and the neutrons, the particle with no
charge. Around the nucleus is the electron, the negatively charged particle.
3. The following are some evidences that support the molecular theory:
20
diffusion – the intermingling of the molecules of substance with the
molecules of the air
capillarity – the rise of liquid on a fine or hair-like tube
surface tension – the formation of a temporary membrane on the surface
of a liquid.
osmosis – the passage of liquid from a semi-permeable membrane or
from a liquid of greater concentration to a liquid of lesser concentration
Cohesion – the attraction between like or the same kind of molecules.
Adhesion – the attraction between unlike or different kinds of molecules
4. The total number of protons in a given atom determines the atomic number of an
element. The atomic number is also equal to the number of electrons.
5. The atomic mass or mass number is the sum of an atom's protons and neutrons
that are always expressed in whole numbers.
6. Symbols are used to represent an element, chemical formula for compound and
chemical equation for chemical reaction.
7. In a chemical reaction, the substances that combine are called reactants, while the
substance/s produced is/are called product/s. An arrow is used to represent a
forward or backward reaction.
8. The law of conservation of mass states that a new atom cannot be created in a
chemical reaction and that the mass of the reactants is equal to the mass of the
products.
21
Posttest
Word search Puzzle
Search and shade the word or words in the puzzle that complete the sentence/s below:
4. ___________ is the intermingling of molecules of the air with the molecules of another
substance.
5. The elements and compound that start up a reaction are the ____________.
7. The force of attraction that exists between molecules of different kinds is called
______________.
11. The negatively charged particles that move around the nucleus are the _____.
17. The mass of the reactants is equal to mass of the products. This is the law of
___________________.
22
18. The passage of liquid from a substance of greater concentration to a less concentration is
known as __________.
19. When two elements or compounds combine in a chemical reaction, this is called
_____________.
A B A R R O W S Y M B O L S S Y N T H
S C D D I F F U S I O N E F G P R O T
H H I J K L P R O D U C T S M N E O A
S U E L C U N F O M P M E T A L A V D
W X Y L Z A B A C D O E E E F G C H H
I A J K L L M C A P I L L A R I T Y E
N T O P Q S O E R S T E E U V W A X S
Y O Z A B M A T O M C M C C D E N E I
G M H I P A J E K L M E T N U O T S O
Q I R O S T T N U V W N R X Y L S I N
A C U R B T C S D E F T O G H I E S K
J N K B L E M I N O P S N C O H E O I
D U Q I R R F O R M U L A S T U V M X
Y M Z T A B C N E Q U A T I O N S S E
F B C O N S E R V A T I O N O G H O J
R E B M U N S S A M K L M N F M A S S
O R S Y N T H E S I S C O H E S I O N
23
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. symbols
2. nucleus
3. element
4. atomic number
5. compound
6. electrons
7. mass number or atomic mass
8. metal
9. ion
10. covalent
11. solution
12. physical
13. molecules
14. catalysts
15. activation energy
16. decomposition or analysis
17. acids
18. bases
19. law of conservation of mass
20. valence electrons
Activity 1.1
Subtract the atomic number from the atomic mass to get the number of neutrons; the
number of protons is equal to the number of electrons.
24
Activity 1.2
Self-test 1.1
COLUMN A COLUMN B
1. compound f. combination of two or more elements
2. nucleus c. small but dense core of the atom
3. neutron h. particle in the nucleus with no charge
4. proton b. positively charged particles in the nucleus
5. shells e. energy states in which the electrons of an atom can exist
6. molecules h. this is formed when atoms combine
7. ionic bond m. involves a shift or transfer of electron from one atom to another
atom
8. metallic bond n. involves a sharing of electrons in metals to another metal
9. covalent bond o. involves a sharing of electron in different kinds of atoms
10. chemical g. used to represent a compound
formula
11. atomic number i. number of protons in the nucleus
12. isotopes l. element having the same atomic number but different atomic
mass
13. electron d. negatively charged particle outside the nucleus of an atom
14. atomic mass a. number of protons and neutrons in the nucleus
15. octet rule l. states that eight electrons are needed to attain stability
25
Plants can receive nutrients through the roots; towels are used to dry up our
body after taking a bath; mops to use dry wet floors, the use of wick alcohol
lamp
3. The water drops formed a sphere-like structure.
Other examples:
Globular formation of mercury; convex shape of ice in an ice tray; the surface
of the water in a container is convex.
4. The molecules of the liquid soap formed a temporary enamel membrane on the
surface of water. When it was touched, the membrane broke up.
Other examples:
Insects can run on a surface of water; detergents are used to wash clothes
(Deter means to remove or put off)
Self-Test 2.1
1. c 2. b 3. c 4. d 5. c
Activity 3.1:
Activity 3.2.
Self-Test 3.1
26
Self-Test 4.1
Posttest
1 2
A B A R R O W S Y M B O L S S Y N T H
3 4 5
S C D D I F F U S I O N E F G P R O T
6 7
H H I J K L P R O D U C T S M N E O A
8 9
S U E L C U N F O M P Q R S T U A V D
10 11
W X Y L Z A B A C D O E E E F G C H H
12 13
I A J K L L M C A P I L L A R I T Y E
N T O P Q S O E R S T E E U V W A X S
14 15
Y O Z A B M A T O M C M C C D E N E I
G M H I P A J E K L M E T N U O T S O
Q I R O S T T N U V W N R X Y L S I N
A C U R B T C S D E F T O G H I E S K
J N K B L E M I N O P S N C O H E O I
16
D U Q I R R F O R M U L A S T U V M X
17
Y M Z T A B C N E Q U A T I O N S S E
18 19
F B C O N S E R V A T I O N O G H O J
R E B M U N S S A M K L M N F M A S S
20
O R S Y N T H E S I S 21C O H E S I O N
-End of Module-
27
References
Chang, R. and Cuickshank, B. Chemistry 8th Ed.. USA: Mc-Graw Hill.
Gebelein, C. G. 2001. Chemistry and our world. USA: WCB Wm. C. Brown Publishers.
Lemay, E , Robblee, K, and Beall, H, Chemistry: Connections to our changing World : Prentice Hall.
Oxtoby, Nachtrieb & Freeman, Chemistry, Science of Change, 2nd Ed.:USA: Saunders College Publishing.
28
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 7
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 7
The Nature of Forces
Motion occurs all around us. We see it in our everyday activities, in children playing in
the neighborhood, in animals roaming in the field, in trees swaying in the wind, and even in
the stars at night. There is also motion that we cannot directly see, like the vibration of
atoms responsible for heat and sound and the flow of electrons that constitutes electricity.
Truly, motion is everywhere.
But what is responsible for all these type of motion? What causes motion? Based on our
experiences, whenever an object at rest moves, we presume that something acting on it
made it move and whenever a moving object slows down and eventually stops, something
acting on it made it stop. In science, this thing that affects motion is called force.
What is a force? What changes are brought about by forces acting on bodies? How do
forces affect motion? What are the different types of forces? How does force and surface
area affect pressure? This module presents some simple activities that will help you
understand the basic concepts about forces.
2
How to learn from this module
This module has been designed to help you understand the basic concepts about
forces. The simple activities that you will perform will help you comprehend the concepts
about forces as they apply to real life situations. By engaging in these learning activities, you
become an active participant in the learning process.
As you go through the module, you are in complete control of the learning process.
Here’s a simple guide for you in going about the module:
3
What to do before (Pretest)
Instructions: Choose the letter of the correct answer. Write the letter on your answer
sheet.
2. What force is responsible for keeping the planets in their orbits as they revolve
around the sun?
a. nuclear
b. magnetic
c. electrical
d. gravitational
5. A sack of rice is hanging from a rope. What term refers to the force exerted by the
rope pulling the sack of rice up?
a. friction
b. tension
c. normal force
d. elastic force
6. What term refers to the force by which all bodies are attracted to the earth?
a. weight
b. tension
c. friction
d. normal force
4
7. What term refers to the quantity force per unit area?
a. mass
b. weight
c. density
d. pressure
8. What type of force is responsible for the slowing down of moving objects on a
surface?
a. friction
b. weight
c. tension
d. normal force
9. How does a negatively charged body interact electrically with a positively charged
body?
a. attract
b. repel
c. either attract or repel
d. it depends on their masses
10. When an atomic bomb explodes, tremendous amount of energy is released. With
what force is this energy associated?
a. weak
b. electric
c. nuclear
d. magnetic
11. For the same force applied, what happens to the pressure if the surface area
where the force is acting is decreased?
a. increases
b. decreases
c. does not change
d. not enough information is given
12. A balloon is squeezed by pushing on its opposite sides. How would this affect the
air pressure inside the balloon?
a. the air pressure increases
b. the air pressure decreases
c. the air pressure does not change
d. not enough information is provided
5
Lesson 1 The Effects of Forces
Forces have always been a part of our everyday experiences. Whether we are doing
our household chores, working in the field, or even playing at school, we can see the effects
of forces in action. For example, in fetching water from a well, you need to exert a force by
pulling the rope up. In moving a car stuck in the mud, you need to exert a force by pushing
it. And in a tug–of–war game, you need to exert a force by pulling the rope as hard as
possible in order to win. These are just some of the many instances that show forces in
action. From these instances, can you see the changes brought about by forces acting on
certain bodies? What are these changes? The following activities will help you find out the
answers to these questions.
Materials: inflated balloon, two books with different sizes, small ball
Procedure:
(b) Pull on the opposite sides of the balloon. Describe what happens to the
balloon.
_________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________
(b) Which is harder to move, the big book or the small book?
_________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________
6
3. Make a small ball roll along the surface of a table.
4. Make the small ball roll along the flat surface of a table.
(b) How do you deflect the ball from its path while it is moving?
_________________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________
The activities you have just performed illustrate the changes brought about by forces
acting on certain bodies. You may have noticed the following changes:
What is responsible for such changes? It is a force. A force is a push or a pull. In part 1,
the size and shape of the balloon can be changed either by pushing or pulling on the
opposite sides of the balloon. In part 2, what made the books move was either a push or a
pull. However, the big book required more effort for it to move than the small book. In part
3, the speed of the rolling ball can be changed by pushing the ball. If the push given to the
ball is in the same direction as its motion, it will move faster. However, if the push given to
the rolling ball is in the opposite direction, it will move slower and will eventually stop. In the
last part, the direction of motion of the rolling ball can be changed by pushing it sideways
either to the right or to the left of its straight-line path.
7
The activities you have just performed demonstrated what a force could do to an object. To
summarize:
What is a force? A force is a push or pull that may cause a change in the object’s
motion, size and shape, or both. How is force measured? A device used in measuring force
in the laboratory is called spring balance. It consists of a coil spring, enclosed in a case for
protection, with a pointer attached to one end. When forces are applied to the ends of a
spring balance, the pointer indicates the amount of elongation that is proportional to the
force applied. The SI unit of force is Newton (N). The weighing scale you see in the market
and the bathroom scale used in weighing a baby are all used to measure force which is the
weight. However, these weighing scales are not calibrated in newtons but in kilograms.
8
Lesson 2 Classification of Forces
In lesson 1, you learned that a force could either be a push or a pull capable of
changing the size or shape, the speed, and the direction of motion of objects. By pulling on
the rope, you can direct a carabao and its cart in the right direction. By pushing a cart, you
can make it move. Based on these instances, it seems that forces are always exerted
through contact. But there are other forces exerted even without physical contact between
the interacting bodies. So how are forces exerted on interacting bodies? The following
activity will help you classify forces based on the way they act on bodies.
Procedure:
1. (a) How do you make a ball at rest on top of a table move?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
(b) Was there contact between your hand and the ball as you try to make it
move?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
2. (a) Hold the same ball at shoulder level and then let go. What happened to the
ball?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
(b) Was there contact between the floor and the ball while it was falling after
being released from your hand?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
The activity you have just performed illustrates that there are two different ways by
which forces act on objects. In part (1), in order for the ball at rest to move, you need to
exert a force on the ball. This force that you exerted on the ball could either be a push or a
pull. As you push or pull the ball, there is physical contact between your hand and the ball.
9
However in part (b), when you let go of the ball at shoulder level, it falls to the floor. As the
ball falls, there must be a force exerted on it that makes it fall. But what could have exerted
this force? It is the floor. The floor exerts an attractive force on the ball even if there is no
physical contact between them. These observations point out that forces could either be
contact forces or non – contact forces.
Contact forces are types of forces in which the two interacting bodies are in
contact as they exert forces on one another.
Materials: book, marble, stone, string, spring, plastic comb, small bits of acetate, two
bar magnets
Procedure:
1. Place a book on top of a table. What keeps the book from falling? How is this
possible?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
2. Roll a marble on top of a level surface. Make it stop. Slide a light book on top of
the same level surface by giving it an initial push. Did the book continue to slide?
What is responsible for making the sliding book slow down and eventually stop?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
3. Tie a small stone at the end of the string. Allow the stone to hang. What keeps
the stone from falling? How is this possible?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
10
4. Drop a small stone and a piece of paper from the same height at the same time.
Observe closely the motion of the stone and the paper as they fall. Which of
them reached the ground first? Why didn’t the other one reach the ground at the
same time as the first? (Try orienting your palm against the direction of the wind.
What do you feel?)
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
5. Attach one end of a spring firmly on a wall. Compress the spring by pushing a
small stone against the free end of the spring. Release the spring. What
happens to the stone? How is this possible?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
6. Rub a plastic comb against your hair. After several strokes, let it approach small
bits of acetate. (Make sure that the comb only approaches the bits of acetate,
not actually touching them). What happens to the small pieces of acetate? How
is this possible?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
7. Let the north pole of a bar magnet approach the north pole of another bar
magnet. Bring them closer together. What do you notice? How do these
magnets interact?
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
This time, let the north pole of the magnet approach the south pole of
another bar magnet. What do you observe? How do these magnets interact?
How do you take them apart?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
11
Read this:
An atom consists of three sub-atomic particles. The protons and neutrons are found
in the nucleus while the electron is orbiting around the nucleus. Why do the protons and
neutrons orbit instead of the electron? What keeps the nuclear particles together? The
protons repel each other because they carry like charges. Evidently, electric forces do not
hold the neutrons together. The gravitational force between the nucleus is too small to be
of importance. There is a third force that holds the nuclear particles together. It is called
nuclear force. The strong nuclear force is a force that holds protons and neutrons
together to form atomic nucleus. The weak nuclear force acts between the elementary
particles and is responsible for radioactive decay called beta decay. This force is involved
in nuclear reactions that occur in stars like the sun.
The activities you have just performed illustrate the different kinds of forces acting on
bodies.
In this activity, a book is at rest on top of a table. Without the table, the book will fall.
Therefore, it is the table that supports the book. How does the table support the book? It
is by applying an upward force on the book. This upward force exerted on the book by
the surface of a table is the normal force. It is always perpendicular to the surface.
A marble is rolling on a flat surface. How could the marble be stopped? It could be
stopped by applying a force opposite to the direction of motion. A marble moving to the
right can be stopped by pushing it to the left.
A book initially at rest on a flat surface can be set into motion by giving it a slight
push. As the book moves, it slows down and then stops. Just like the marble, the book
slowed down and eventually stopped. This means that there must be a force exerted on
the book opposite to the direction of motion. But what object could have exerted this
force? It is the flat surface. As the book slides, the surfaces of the book and the floor in
contact offer opposition to motion. This opposition is the force exerted on the book
opposite to the direction of motion. This force that opposes motion is called friction.
A small stone tied at the end of a string hangs at rest. What keeps the stone from
falling? It is the string. How could the string prevent the stone from falling? It is by pulling
the stone upward. This force exerted by a string on opposite sides is known as tension.
The tensions on opposite sides of a string are equal.
12
A stone and a piece of paper dropped from the same height
When a stone and a piece of paper are dropped from the same height, which
reaches the ground first? The stone reaches the ground first. Why? Is it because the
stone is heavier than the paper? No.
Both the stone and the paper are attracted to the ground. The force of attraction
exerted by the earth on objects in its surface is the gravitational force. However, as the
paper falls, there is another force that acts on it. This force exerted by the air on the
paper is opposite to the direction of motion just like friction. This force causes the paper
to be left behind by the stone. This force exerted by the air opposite in direction to the
motion of an object is known as air resistance.
The paper can be made to reach the ground at the same time as the stone by
crumpling it. Doing so reduces the air resistance on the paper.
When the compressed spring is released, a stone attached at its free end is thrown
forward. What made it possible for the stone to move forward? It is the force exerted on it
by the spring. The force exerted by a compressed or stretched spring is known as the
elastic force.
When a plastic comb is rubbed against your hair, it gains the ability to pick up bits of
acetate. This happens because of the transfer of charges between the plastic comb and
the hair. We say that the plastic comb is charged. The plastic comb interacts with small
pieces of acetate by attracting them. The force exerted between electrically charged
bodies is known as the electric force. Charges could either be positive or negative.
Charges with like sign repel each other; charges with unlike sign attract each other.
When the north pole of one magnet is brought close to the north pole of another
magnet, they repel each other. It will be harder to move them closer together as they
approach one another. However, when the north pole of a magnet is brought close to the
south pole of another magnet, they attract each other. This force exerted by the poles of
a magnet is known as magnetic force.
The activities you have just performed illustrate that forces could be classified into
contact and non–contact forces. The table below shows how these forces are classified.
13
Contact Forces Non–Contact Force
14
Lesson 3 Pressure
Whenever you listen to a weather forecast over the radio, you will usually hear the term
low-pressure associated with a coming typhoon. When inflating a bicycle tire, you make sure
that you inflate it with the right pressure because too much pressure on the tire might cause
it to burst. In some subdivisions where water supply is insufficient, the flow of water out of
the faucet is weak because of low water pressure. These instances show that we often
make use of the word ‘pressure’ in everyday conversations. But what exactly is pressure?
This lesson discusses the basic concepts about pressure as it is used in science. It will
describe how pressure is related to force and the surface area over which the force acts.
Materials: a wide pan filled with flour, about 5 cm deep, two identical rectangular
wooden blocks, a heavy stone
Procedure:
1. (a) Lay the two rectangular wooden blocks horizontally on the flour. What do you
notice about the depression on the flour made by the two blocks?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
(b) What happens to these depressions on the flour when you put a heavy stone on
top of one of the blocks?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
2. (a) Lay the first rectangular wooden block horizontally on the flour and the other
vertically. What do you notice about the depression made by these blocks on
the flour?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
15
(b) How do you keep the depression made by the blocks constant without changing
the orientation of the blocks?
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
____________________________________________________________
In the activity that you have just performed, the pressure exerted by the wooden blocks
is indicated by the depression made on the flour. The greater the pressure, the deeper is the
depression.
In activity 1, when the two wooden blocks were laid horizontally on the flour, they created
the same extent of depression. Why? It is because the two wooden blocks have exerted the
same force on the flour over the same surface area. The same force exerted on the flour
because the wooden blocks are identical, having equal weights. The surface area of the
application of the force is the same because the faces of the wooden blocks that are in
contact with the floor are the same. However, when a heavy stone is placed on top of one of
the blocks, the depression on the flour made by that block changes. What could be the
reason for this? Clearly, it is not the area of the application of the force because identical
faces of the blocks are still in contact with the flour. Therefore, it is the difference in the force
applied to the flour that caused the difference in the extent of the depression. With the
addition of the stone, the force applied by that block on the flour has increased. In turn, the
depression on the flour has also increased. This means that pressure exerted by the block
increases.
In activity 2, the two blocks differed in terms of extent of depression made on the flour.
The block oriented vertically made the greater depression on the flour than the one oriented
horizontally. This could not be attributed to the forces they exert on the flour because they
have equal weights. Instead, this could be attributed to the difference in the area of the
block in contact with the flour. The one oriented vertically has a smaller area of contact with
the flour than the one oriented horizontally. This allows the block oriented vertically to exert
a greater force per unit area on the flour.
The results of the activity you have just performed are summarized in the table below.
16
Based on the results of the activity, we can come up with two basic concepts about the
relation of pressure, force and area.
For the same force applied, pressure is inversely proportional to the surface
area where the force is applied. The greater the surface area, the smaller the
pressure; the smaller the surface area, the greater the pressure.
Therefore, in science, pressure is defined as the force exerted per unit area. In an
equation:
If force is expressed in newtons and the area in square meters, pressure is expressed in
pascals.
Instruction: Choose the letter of the correct answer. Write the letter only.
1. If you blow more air into a balloon, what happens to the pressure?
a. increases
b. decreases
c. stays the same
2. For the same force applied, what happens to the pressure if the surface area where
the force acting is decreased?
a. increases
b. decreases
c. stays the same
3. What happens to the pressure if the force applied on the same surface area is
decreased?
a. increases
b. decreases
c. stays the same
17
4. In which case is the pressure exerted greater: object A with weight 10 N with surface
area in contact with table equal to 5 cm2 or object B with weight 20 N with surface
area in contact with the table equal to 10 cm2?
a. object A
b. object B
c. the same pressure is exerted
5. A balloon is squeezed by pushing on its opposite sides. How would this affect the air
pressure inside the balloon?
a. the air pressure increases
b. the air pressure decreases
c. the air pressure does not change
d. not enough information is provided
Let’s summarize
After going through all the activities in this module, let us summarize the basic concepts
about forces and how they affect objects.
1. A force is capable of changing the size and shape of an object, its speed, and its
direction of motion. The SI unit of the force is the Newton.
2. Forces are classified into contact and non–contact forces. Contact forces are
exerted on interacting bodies that are in physical contact with one another. Non –
contact forces or action at a distance forces are exerted when the interacting
bodies are not in physical contact with one another.
5. The gravitational force is the force of attraction between any two objects in the
universe.
6. Air resistance is the force exerted by the air opposite to the direction of the motion
of a falling object.
18
8. Electric force is the force exerted by electrically charged objects
10. Nuclear force is a force that holds the nuclear particles together.
11. Pressure is defined as force exerted over a certain surface area. Its SI unit is the
Pascal. For the same force exerted, the greater the surface area, the smaller the
pressure. For the same surface area, the greater the force, the greater is the
pressure.
Posttest
Instructions: Choose the letter of the correct answer. Write the letter only on your
answer sheet.
3. A girl hangs at rest at the end of a rope tied to the ceiling. What provides the
support force for the girl?
a. tension
b. weight
c. friction
d. normal force
4. What will happen to a body made to slide across a frictionless level surface?
a. Its speed will increase.
b. Its speed will decrease
c. Its speed will remain the same.
d. It will stop.
19
5. In which of the following cases is there net force acting on a body?
a. a body moving at constant speed along a circular path
b. a body at rest on top of a table
c. a body moving along a frictionless surface
d. none of the above
6. A rock is hanging from a rope. What term refers to the force exerted by the rope
on the rock?
a. Elastic force
b. Friction
c. Normal force
d. Tension
8. When you rubbed a comb against your hair and put it near small bits of paper, the
paper clings to the comb. What force explains this observation?
a. weak force
b. electrical force
c. magnetic force
d. nuclear Force
9. What force is responsible for keeping an electron in its orbit as it goes around the
nucleus of an atom?
a. weak force
b. electrical force
c. magnetic force
d. nuclear Force
10. A ball is thrown upward. When it reaches its maximum height, it stops. What force
acts on the ball?
a. friction
b. weight
c. normal force
d. air resistance
11. Two identical cars A and B have the same mass. What can you say about the
pressure of the air in the tires if in car A the tires have a greater area of contact
with the ground compared to that of car B?
a. the air pressure of the tires in car A is greater than that in car B
b. the air pressure of the tires in car A is less than that in car B
c. the air pressure of the tires in car A is equal to that in car B
d. cannot be determined from the information given
20
12. Two identical glasses are filled with different substances. Glass A is filled with
water while glass B is filled with sand. Which of the two exerts a greater pressure
on the table?
a. Glass A
b. Glass B
c. Both A and B
21
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. a 6. a 11. a
2. d 7. d 12. a
3. a 8. a
4. d 9. a
5. b 10. c
Self–Test 1.1
4. A spring balance can be used to measure forces. The amount of force being
measured is proportional to the elongation of the spring. This elongation is calibrated
in Newtons.
5. a. change in shape
b. change in speed
c. change in direction
d. change in shape
e. all the changes listed are possible
Self–Test 2.1
22
Self–Test 3.1
1. a
2. a
3. b
4. c
5. a
Posttest
1. d 6. d 11. b
2. d 7. c 12. b
3. a 8. a
4. d 9. b
5. a 10. b
-End of Module-
Reference
Hewitt, P.G. (2000) Conceptual Physics: The high school physics program. New Jersey: Prentice – Hall Inc. New
Jersey
23
References:
24
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 8
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 8
The Energy Story
This module takes you on a quick tour of the world of energy- from its sources, uses,
forms, transformations from one form to another and transfer from one object to another. It
discusses the impacts of energy on our everyday lives including its practical uses, its
hazards and ways to address such problems. It also gives a brief review of the concept of
work and its applications in simple machines. This module also imbues you with awareness
of and concern for the emerging global and local energy problems. Consequently, it gives
you insights on the wise use of energy.
Lesson 1 - Work
Lesson 2 - Simple Machines
Lesson 3 - Energy
Lesson 4 - Sources of Energy
Lesson 5 - Using Energy Wisely
2
How to learn from this module
For this module to be of great help and use to you, it is important that as a reader,
you devote ample time in reading and understanding its content and in performing the
activities as directed. The topics are arranged according to complexity, so it is necessary not
to skip any part. Take time answering the pre-test because aside from measuring your initial
knowledge on the subject, it also provides you with a review of the concepts that you may
have learned in elementary school.
I. Reshuffle the letters in the boxes to form and identify the term referred in each
number. A mystery box (the one without a letter in it) should be supplied with a
correct letter to complete the word. Good luck!
3
5. It is a method of heat transfer that does not need a
R A A O
medium but electromagnetic waves. The energy
T I I N from the sun is transferred to objects on earth by
this method.
II. Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the following questions.
11. The zigzag road that leads us from the foot to the top of a mountain is an example of
what kind of simple machine?
a. inclined plane c. screw
b. lever d. wheel and axle
12. Which of the following energy transformation occurs when a battery is used in a
flashlight?
a. light-chemical-thermal c. chemical-thermal-light
b. chemical-electrical-thermal d. chemical-electrical-light
13. What source of energy supplies the energy needed by photovoltaic cells?
a. Getothermal c. Solar
b. Biomas d. Hydroelectric
14. To save energy at home, which of the following should you do?
a. Use fluorescent lamps instead of incandescent bulbs
b. Open windows to allow natural ventilation
c. Iron clothes in bulk, not individually
d. All of the above
4
15. When the pendulum bob swings back and forth, energy is converted from kinetic to
potential and vice versa. At what point in its motion does the bob posses greatest
potential energy?
B D
C
How did you find the pretest? Were you challenged? If you did not score high, do not
worry. You will be learning about these concepts as you go on with this module. Are you
ready to learn?
Lesson 1 Work
The word work has several meanings to different people. Your parent or guardian
probably leaves for work everyday. A homework is a task that a teacher asks you to do at
home on your own time. In science, work has a different meaning.
Let us consider the following statements. Your parents tell you, “We’ve got some
work to do!” An athlete says “I am going to the gym to work out.” Your friend suggests, “Let
us work out this science problem”
In all of the three statements, you notice that the term work refers to an action or
activity to be done. However, in science there is a more precise definition of work,
somehow related to the given statements, but defined specifically in terms of energy, force
and motion.
How are energy, force and motion related to work? To find this out, perform this
simple activity and answer the question that follow.
5
What you will do
Activity 1.1 Doing Work
Directions: Perform each of these activities. Then answer the questions that
follow.
In science, work is done when a force acts upon an object to cause a displacement.
There are three key words in this definition - force, displacement, and cause. Remember
that displacement refers to the change in position of an object with respect to a reference
point. In order for a force to qualify as having done work on an object, there must be a
displacement and the force must cause the displacement in the same direction as the force
applied.
No motion Motion
Force Force Motion
Force
6
What you will do
Activity 1.2 Doing Work
Consider again Activity 1.1 and find out in which activities did you do work. Fill in the
table below. Put a check mark (√) for yes and a cross mark (x) for no in the columns. If you
are done, then check your answer on page 24.
Activity Did you Did the Are the directions of Is there work
exert a object the force applied and done in the
force on move? object’s motion the objects?
the object? same?
Pushing a
concrete wall
Lifting a ball
pen
Climbing up a
stair
There are other several good examples of work which can be observed in everyday
life - a horse pulling a plow through the fields, a father pushing a grocery cart down the aisle
of a grocery store, a freshman lifting a backpack full of books upon her shoulder, a
weightlifter lifting a barbell above her head or an Olympian launching the shot-put. In each
case described, there is a force exerted upon an object to cause that object to be displaced.
7
What you will do
Self-test 1.1 When is work done?
Read the following five statements and determine whether or not they represent
examples of work.
The amount of work done on an object can be calculated by multiplying the force
exerted on it by the displacement the object moved. If we represent work as W, force as F
and displacement as d, then the equation for work is
W = Fxd
With this, we are assuming that the directions of the force and object’s displacement
are the same. Hence, when you exerted a force of 3 Newton in moving a crate 2 meters, the
work that you do on the object is 6 N.m or 6 Joules because 1 N.m is equal to 1 Joule of
work.
Force Displacement
2m Work = F x d
3N =3Nx2m
= 6 Nm
=6J
8
Now, it is your turn. Try solving the given problem on the next page.
Calculate the work done in pushing a box 2 meters across the floor with a
force of 12 N. What happens to the work that you do when you double the force that
you exert?
Throughout the centuries, humans have been challenged to make life easier.
Consequently, we continually invent tools to make jobs less difficult. Today, we know these
tools as machines.
We use machines at home. We use washing machines to wash our clothes, electric
fans to provide ventilation and hairdryer to dry our hair after a bath. Can you identify useful
machines that you find in school?
9
Who discovered the first simple machine?
Thousands of years ago, a caveman named "Ug Lee," needed a better way to cut up
the Woolly Mammoth that he stoned to death. He took his favorite rock, and tried his best to
remove some choice morsels. However he realized that his trusty rock just wasn't
completing the job. His wife "Hoam" told Ug that he should try her favorite stick. Ug realized
that if he attached his favorite rock to Hoam's favorite stick, his job might be a little simpler.
Thus, Ug and Hoam Lee invented the first simple machine.
The tools most people think about when they hear the word "machine" are actually a
combination of two or more simple machines. A simple machine is any device that helps us
perform our work more easily when a force is applied on it. A screw, wheelbarrow and a
bottle opener are all simple machines. To make these simple machines do work for us, we
need to apply a force on them.
Simple machines can help us in many ways. These machines allow us to use a
smaller force to overcome a larger force. They help us change the direction of the force and
work at a faster rate.
Basically, there are six types of simple machines: the inclined plane, wedge, screw,
levers, pulley, and the wheel and axle. These are shown in figure 1.
10
Let us discuss each simple machine one by one…
Inclined Plane
The inclined plane is the simplest of all machines. It is a sloping surface that connects
two points together. We call it a ramp like the ones people use to load or unload heavy
objects from a truck. The longer the ramp, the easier it is to roll an object on it but the
longer it takes for work to be done.
Wedge
A wedge is a simple machine shaped like an inclined plane. A wedge is actually like a
moving inclined plane that is viewed as if standing on its narrow end. A small force applied
to the wide end of a wedge whose narrow end is being pushed into something will send a
strong force pushing out at the sides. We can use the wedge action to cut and shape ice
and wood sculptures, clay or whatever. When an axe, a kind of wedge, bangs into a log, the
log splits open.
A wedge may seem like a simple tool but its importance cannot be underestimated.
A shovel acts as a wedge while you shovel the sand or soil. It's a lot easier to move an
object using a wedge than with bare hands.
Screw
A screw is also another type of inclined plane that connects two ends together and
winds around a core. The screw available at hardware shops is a typical example of this
machine. The road winding up the mountain can also be considered a big screw. We can
go up the mountain with this type of inclined plane. However, again a lot of effort will be
needed if the slope is very steep.
Lever
The lever is a simple machine made with a bar free to move about a fixed point called
a fulcrum. The lever consists of three parts: fulcrum, load and a rod or plank. Levers are
classified into three classes: first, second and third classes, depending on the positions of its
parts on a simple machine
Let's see how each lever is grouped under their individual properties.
The first class lever is the one with the fulcrum in the center. In class, the fulcrum is
the edge of the tin of biscuits. The load is much nearer to the fulcrum than the effort.
Therefore we can use a small force to pull out the nail compared to pulling it out directly
without using the lever. Also notice that the lever changes the direction of the force. As the
handle of the spoon goes down, the lid goes up.
For the second class lever the load is in the center. Whenever the load is nearer to
the fulcrum, the effort needed to lift the load will be less.
11
The third class lever however, is the disadvantageous one. It has the effort in the
center. No matter how close or how far the load is from the fulcrum, the effort used to lift the
load, has to be greater than the load!
The wheel and axle looks like a kind of lever. A wheel and axle is made up of a small
rod which is the axle, stuck rigidly to a large wheel so that when the wheel turns, the rod
stuck to it also turns. A good example of this machine are the screw drivers and electric fans
we use at home.
Can you identify which is the wheel and axle in the two given examples?
Pulley
A pulley is a wheel over which a rope, chain or belt passes. The pulley is usually
used to lift a heavy object (load). A pulley changes the direction of the force, making it easier
to lift things to high-rise areas.
A B C
Figure 2.2 Types of Pulleys: (A) Fixed, (B) Movable and (C) Combined
A fixed pulley is the only pulley that when used individually, uses more effort than the
load to lift the load from the ground. The fixed pulley when attached to an unmovable object
e.g. a ceiling or wall, acts as a first class lever with the fulcrum being located at the axis but
with a minor change, the bar becomes a rope. The advantage of the fixed pulley is that you
do not have to pull or push the pulley up and down. The disadvantage is that you have to
apply more effort than the load.
12
A movable pulley is a pulley that moves with the load. The movable pulley allows the
effort to be less than the weight of the load. The movable pulley also acts as a second-class
lever. The load is between the fulcrum and the effort. The main disadvantage of a movable
pulley is that you have to pull or push the pulley up or down. Its main advantage is you use
less effort to pull the load.
A combined pulley makes life easier as the effort needed to lift the load is less than
half the weight of the load. The main advantage of this pulley is the amount of effort needed
is less than half of the load. Its main disadvantage is it travels a very long distance.
Materials:
Large books, ruler, one cup of rice inside a small plastic sandwich bag (closed with a
twist tie), rubber band strip tied to the top of the bag
Procedure:
Stack the books in one pile. Lean one book against the other to create an inclined
plane. Place the bag of rice on the table. While holding the end of the rubber band,
lift the bag of rice straight up to the top of your book stack. Use the ruler to measure
the length of the rubber band. Now put the bag of rice at the bottom of the inclined
plane and drag it to the top of the stack of books by pulling on the rubber band.
When it is almost to the top, measure the length of the rubber band.
1. What simple machine reduces the length of the rubber band in this
experiment?
2. Why was the rubber band more stretched when the bag was lifted straight up
into the air?
13
To recall the things you have just learned, why don’t you answer this crossword puzzle?
Across
Down
Lesson 3 Energy
Energy is one of the most important concepts in science, but it is hard to define in just
a few words because it could not be seen although its effects can be observed.
What is energy? We have heard the word energy all our life. We say that small
children have a lot of energy. They are always running instead of walking, jumping instead
of stepping. We also say that we need to eat to gain energy after a day’s work. We can also
say that the blocks in the walls of our home have energy. Energy is everywhere in nature-
sunlight, wind, water, plants, and animals. We use energy everyday.
Energy is the ability to do work. We say that an object has energy if it can produce a
change in itself or in its surroundings. In other words, an object with energy can do work or
can use up the energy. The amount of energy you expend in moving something is equal to
14
the work done on it. This is why both work and energy have the same unit of measurement
– Joules in the SI system.
Forms of Energy
Although energy occurs in many forms, the two most fundamental of which are
potential and kinetic energies. Potential energy is the energy of a body due to its position or
location. If a book is lifted from a lower to a higher height, the amount of work done on it is
equal to the potential energy it gains.
Potential energy maybe gravitational, elastic, chemical or magnetic. A huge rock that
is about to fall from a high cliff has gravitational potential energy. The food that we eat, the
fuel that we use and the batteries of our flashlights have stored chemical energy. A spring or
rubber band compressed and stretched have elastic potential energy. The attraction and
repulsion of magnets have magnetic potential energy.
Potential energy in any form is stored for future use. When put to use, this energy is
transformed into kinetic energy, the energy in motion. All moving objects possess kinetic
energy, which like potential energy, also exists in many forms. The electricity flowing
through wires has electrical energy, the candle’s burning flame has thermal energy and a
vibrating guitar string has sound energy.
A good example of kinetic and potential energy is a frog leaping. A frog sitting on a
lily pad possesses potential energy. The frog leaping is an example of kinetic energy.
To compute an object’s kinetic energy, we just need to get one half of the product of
the mass and the square of velocity of an object. In equation form
K.E. = ½ mv2
15
If mass is in kilograms and velocity in meters per second, then the unit of kinetic
energy is Joules. How do you compare the units of work and kinetic energy?
K.E. = ½ mv2
K. E. = ½ (40-kg) (3 m/s)2
KE = ½ (40 kg) (9 ms/s)2
KE = 180 kgm2/s2 = 180 J
Potential energy depends on three quantities: object’s mass and position (height) and
acceleration due to gravity. Its value can be calculated by simply getting the product of the
three quantities. In equation form
When a 1.5 kg book is resting on top of a 2-m high table, then its potential energy is
PE = mhg
PE = (1.5 kg) (2 m) (9.8 m/s2)
1. What is the kinetic energy of a 1.2 kg ball that is thrown at a velocity of 6 m/s?
2. What is its potential energy upon hitting the net that is located 3 meters from the
ground?
16
Forms of Energy
Energy constantly changes from one form to another as it changes everything around
it. There are numerous forms of energy, but we will describe the ones important to us.
Light is energy that moves in the form of waves from the sun and other stars. The
waves are ordered according to their wavelength to form electromagnetic spectrum of
radiation (light energy). Gamma rays have the highest frequency (shortest wavelength) of
the spectrum and therefore carry the most energy. Radio waves have the lowest frequency
(longest wavelength) and therefore carry the least energy. Visible light is in the middle but
takes up only a small portion of the spectrum.
Thermal energy is the total energy of the particles in a material. This includes both
the potential and the kinetic energy of the particles.
Nuclear energy comes from nuclear fission and fusion. Nuclear fission occurs when
a free proton is shot at an atom of uranium or plutonium (because of their large nucleus) and
it explodes into two smaller nuclei, also releasing several more protons, which explode other
nuclei, causing a chain reaction. It then heats up to millions of degrees. Nuclear fusion
occurs when atoms of tritium and deuterium are heated up to the point where the atoms
bang into each other so hard that they fuse together, forming an unstable form of helium,
then the free neutron explodes. This explosion causes the fuel to heat up more than you
originally heated it. This occurs on the sun and other stars, which is why they release so
much energy.
An object may have one or as many other forms of energy. Within the object, such
energies may change from one form to another but the object’s total energy never changes.
This is the law of conservation of energy.
17
Transformation of Energy
What do you feel when you rub your palms together for a few seconds? Do you feel
your palms turn warm? What if you rub your palms together more briskly? Do they get even
warmer? How did this happen? What happens when you place your warm hands on your
cheek?
By rubbing your palms together, you exert a force to overcome friction between your
palms. This force comes from the stored chemical energy in the food that you eat. Work is
done when you apply this force in moving you palms against each other. By this doing, two
other forms of energy -heat and sound- are generated. When you do more work by rubbing
your hands more briskly, more heat is produced.
Your cheeks likewise feel warm when you touch them with your hands because the
thermal energy in your palms is transferred to your cheeks.
Sound Energy
Sound produced
by palms
Can you trace the energy transformation when a monkey leaps from tree to tree?
Using the illustrations as clues, write in the boxes the conversion of the monkey’s energy.
Turn to the next page and have a try!
18
What you will do
Activity 3.2 Transformation of Energy
1.
3.
2.
4.
6.
5. Photo credit:
http://www.flyingturtle.org/energy/energy-1.htm
19
Solar Energy
Solar energy is light and heat energy from the sun. Solar
cells convert sunlight into electrical energy while thermal
collectors convert sunlight into heat energy. Solar technologies
are used in watches, calculators, water pumps, space satellites,
for heating water, and supplying clean electricity to the power
grid. There is enough solar radiation striking the surface of the
earth to provide all of our energy needs.
Fig. 4.1 Solar cells
There are two main ways of using solar energy to produce electricity. These are
through the use of solar cells and solar thermal technology. Using solar technologies to
generate electricity is, at present, more expensive than using coal-fired power stations, but it
produces much less pollution.
Solar cells are photovoltaic cells that turn light into electricity. Solar cells are used in
three main ways. They are used in small electrical items, like calculators, and for remote
area power supplies, like telephones and space satellites. Today, solar cells are also used
to a limited extent in the development of solar-powered vehicles
Wind Energy
If a dam or barrage is built across a river mouth or inlet, electricity can be obtained by
the flow of water through turbines in the dam as the tide rises and falls. The movement of
waves can also drive air turbines to make electricity.
Biomass Energy
Biomass is plant and animal material that can be used for energy. This includes using
wood from trees, waste from other plants (for example, bagasse from sugar cane) and
manure from livestock. Biomass can be used to generate electricity, light, heat, motion and
fuel. Converting biomass energy into useable energy has many environmental benefits. It
uses waste materials that are usually dumped, and uses up methane (a greenhouse gas).
Fuels such as ethanol can be made from biomass and used as an alternative to petrol to
power motorcars.
20
All plant and animal matter is called biomass. It is the mass of biological matter on
earth. We can get energy directly from plants by burning wood for cooking and heating and
from animal wastes, for example biogas (mainly methane gas) from sewage and manure.
Hydroelectric Energy
Fast-flowing water released from dams in mountainous areas can turn water turbines
to produce electricity. While it doesn't cause pollution, there are many other environmental
impacts to consider. Ecosystems may be destroyed, cultural sites may be flooded and
sometimes people need to be resettled. There are also impacts on fish breeding, loss of
wildlife habitat and changes in water flow of rivers.
Places with high rainfall and steep mountains are ideal for hydroelectricity. Can you
identify some places in the Philippines that may be good location for a hydroelectric power
plant?
Geothermal Energy
Geothermal energy uses heat energy from beneath the surface of the earth. Some of
this heat finds its way to the surface in the form of hot springs or geysers. Other schemes
tap the heat energy by pumping water through hot dry rocks several kilometers beneath the
earth's surface.
Coal
Coal is a fossil fuel formed over millions of years from decomposing plants. Coal is
mainly burned in power stations to make electricity. When coal is burned it produces large
amounts of carbon dioxide, one of the gases responsible for the enhanced greenhouse
effect (the increase in the world's temperature due to the increased insulating effect of the
earth's atmosphere).
Petroleum
Petroleum, or crude oil, is formed in a similar way as coal. But instead of becoming a
rock, it becomes a liquid trapped between layers of rocks. It can be made into gas, petrol,
kerosene, diesel fuel, oils and bitumen. These products are used in houses for heating and
cooking and in factories as a source of heat energy. They are also used in power stations
and can provide fuel for transport. However their use, especially petrol and diesel, produces
large amounts of carbon dioxide emissions. It also produces other poisonous gases that
may harm the environment and people's health.
21
Gas
Gas is made in the same way as petroleum and is also trapped between layers of
rock. Natural gas is tapped, compressed and piped into homes to be used in stoves and hot
water systems. LPG (Liquefied Petroleum Gas) is made from crude oil. It is used for cooking
and heating in homes, industrial heating in boilers, kilns and furnaces, and for camping and
caravanning appliances. LPG can also be used as an alternative to petrol as an engine and
transport fuel.
Nuclear Energy
Nuclear energy is the energy released when atoms are either split or joined together.
A mineral called uranium is usually used in this process. Heat energy and steam produced
can drive an electricity generator in a power station, or provide direct mechanical power in a
ship or submarine. At each stage of the process various types of radioactive waste are
produced. This waste is poisonous and can cause harm to people and the environment
coming into contact with it.
To recap the most common energy sources, try answering this crossword puzzle.
Across
Down
1. Examples are coal, oil and natural gas
2. A device that can convert sunlight directly to
electricity.
6. It is harnessed by windmills to produce energy
22
Lesson 5 Using Energy Wisely
We use energy to do work everyday. Most of the time, it is easier to make use of
those that come from non-renewable sources because of their availability in the market, for
example, the gasoline that serves as fuel for our cars, motors and equipment and the LPG
gas that we use to cook our food. Our growing energy consumption and depleting energy
sources pose a great problem because we are using more energy than we produce.
To solve this problem, we can only do two things: tap more renewable sources, which
surely will cost us more, or use the available energy wisely. We cannot do anything with the
non-renewable energy sources because they involve natural processes. For instance, say it
takes million of years before fossil fuels are formed. But we can always save and economize
on our available energy.
Can you think of ways on how you can save more energy at home and in school? Do
the next activity.
Identify the available energy forms in your school and home and list down ways to
use them wisely. You may use additional sheets of paper.
School
23
Let’s summarize
1. Work is done by a force on an object when the force causes the object to be
displaced.
2. Simple machines are devices that help us do work more easily. They can either
multiply or change the direction of the force.
3. Energy is the ability to do work. Energy has different forms and sources.
4. Potential energy is the energy due to an object’s position. Potential energy can be
computed by finding the product of the object’s mass, position (height) and
acceleration due to gravity.
5. Kinetic energy is the energy possessed by moving objects. Kinetic energy is one half
the product of mass and the square of the velocity of an object.
7. Energy cannot be created or destroyed but can only be transformed from one form to
another.
10. Shortage and high production cost of energy sources pose a problem to the
community with growing population. It is important that we make use of our energy
resources wisely to ensure that there is enough supply for future use.
24
Posttest
Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the questions or completes the
statements.
1. Work is done in all of the following instances EXCEPT when
a. pushing a locked door
b. raising a window
c. climbing stairs
d. scrubbing a floor
4. A 400- kg truck is traveling at 8 m/s. What is the car’s kinetic energy when it stops?
a. 0 J
b. 8 J
c. 3200 J
d. 6400 J
6. Which of the following gives the correct order of energy transformation in a burning
candle?
a. Thermal – Radiant – Chemical
b. Chemical – Thermal – Radiant
c. Chemical – Radiant – Thermal
d. Thermal – Chemical – Radiant
25
7. When you put your palms close to a fire, your hands will eventually feel warm even
without touching the fire. What method of heat transfer is involved in this situation?
a. Conduction
b. Convection
c. Radiation
d. Transformation
8. A physics book and a chemistry book of equal mass are piled up so that the physics
book rests over the chemistry book. Which of the following statements is correct?
a. The physics book has more KE than the chemistry book.
b. The physics book has more PE than the chemistry book.
c. The two books have the same PE and KE.
d. The chemistry book is doing work on the chemistry book.
9. The acceleration due to gravity on the moon’s surface is 1/6 that of the acceleration
due to gravity on earth’s surface. If you walk at 1 m/s on a flat moon’s surface, just as
you walk here on the earth, which of these statements is correct?
a. Your KE on earth is less than your KE on moon
b. Your KE on earth is more than your KE on moon
c. Your PE on earth is less than your PE on moon
d. Your PE on earth is more than your PE on moon
10. How much energy do you use when you exert a 5-N force to move a box to a
distance of 3 m?
a. 0 J
b. 15 J
c. 45 J
d. 75 J
26
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. Energy 2. Geothermal 3. Kinetic 4. Lever 5. Radiation
6. Biomass 7. renewable 8.Convection 9. Pulley 10. Work
Activity 1.2
Activity 2.2
Across: 3. Fulcrum 4. Inclined Plane 6. Wheel and Axle
Down: 1. Pulley 2. Screw 5. Lever 6. Wedge
27
Activity 3.2
Every cell in the monkey's body is constantly converting the stored solar
energy in glucose into work and heat. The work is used to carry on cell processes
like growing, reproducing, moving molecules around, and getting rid of waste. The
heat is a byproduct of the fuel "burning" process. Heat is always given off when fuel
is burned, whether it is in a diesel engine or an animal cell. In an animal the heat can
be used to help keep its body at a certain warm temperature. Sometimes our bodies
make too much heat (especially if we are dancing to loud music) and we have to do
things like sweat or pant (if we are dogs) or fan our big heat exchanger ears (if we are
elephants) to try to cool down.
All of the heat flows eventually into the surrounding air. The quantity of total
energy has not and will not change. It has just moved to different forms and different
places.
Source: http://www.flyingturtle.org/energy/energy-1.htm
Activity 4.1
Across 1. Fission 3. Fusion 4. Hydroelectric 5. Renewable
Down 1. Nonrenewable 2. Solar cell 6. Wind
28
Activity 5.1. Note: These are just suggested answers. You may see your
teacher for checking of other answers.
Posttest 1. a 2. c 3. a 4. a 5. a
6. b 7. b 8. b 9. d 10. b
-End of Module-
References
Young, H. D. and Freedman, R. A. (1996). University Physics, 9th Ed. USA: Addison-Wesley Publishing
Company.
Resnick, R. et al. (2002). Physics, Fifth Edition. USA:John Wiley and Sons, Inc
29
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 9
1
Module 9
Organism and its Home
This module is all about the organism and its home. It will discuss an organism’s
environment and its basic components and functional structures. As human beings, we are
a significant component of this home, thus, learning about the environment is a must. As
you read the module, it will bring you to the wonderful environment that we live in and the
wonders of how it works.
To make the discussion easy for you, the module is divided into two lessons:
2
What to do before (Pre-test)
Take the pretest before proceeding in the lessons. Check your answers against the
answer key at the end of the module.
3. What do you call a group or collection of similar organisms living in a given area?
a. ecotypes c. population
b. organism d. community
a. ecosystem c. ecology
b. niche d. habitat
6. What is the branch of science that deals with the study of the interactions between the
living and the non-living components of the environment?
a. Entomology c. Ecology
b. Economics d. Environmental Science
a. habitat c. decomposer
b. niche d. producer
3
9. The biggest Biosphere II experiment in history was conducted in:
a. US c. Canada
b. Japan d. Australia
10. The part of the biosphere that is composed of the body of water:
a. Atmosphere c. lithosphere
b. Hemisphere d. hydrosphere
_________4. Energy flows because of the interaction of the living and the non-living
components.
4
Lesson 1 The Environment
Do you know where you live in the biosphere? You see some of us live in places that
experience four seasons in a year while others experience only two seasons. Usually, it is
the geographical location of the country that determines the type of climate of the place. If
you have a globe, you can locate where your country lies. Most countries along the equator
do not experience four seasons in one year. Only those close to the north pole and the
south pole do.
Have you ever gone for a walk in the morning or late in the afternoon and noticed the
things that surround you? You must have been amazed with the beauty of nature! You have
probably observed the birds, the plants, the rocks, and the soil as you passed by. Do you
live in an area that has thick forests, mountains and hills or a place similar to the picture
above? You must be very lucky since most of our trees are already gone. We barely have
20% of the original forests that we used to enjoy.
Would you like to know more about your surroundings? If yes, turn the page and do
Activity 1.1.
5
What you will do
Activity 1.1 Exploring your environment
Materials:
1 x 1 m quadrat
hand lens
4 pegs
mirror
a basin half filled with water
a sheet of white paper
record book
Procedure:
2. When you are through with the living components, you can start
working on the soil of your study area. Note the following:
a. color
b. size of particles
c. type of soil according to texture
d. condition of the soil (wet, dry, flooded)
6
You have just explored your surroundings. Now, notice that it is composed of living
and non-living things. The non-living factors of the environment may affect the community
of living things in the area and vice versa. It is not only the living organisms that can modify
the environment but the environment can also modify the living organisms. Say for example,
if man will pollute the seawater, he could change the chemistry of the seawater, and this
change in the chemistry of the seawater can generate some changes in the surroundings
which may even lead to the overgrowth of some microscopic organisms like the
dinoflagellates, which could ultimately result to the occurrence of red tide. Are you familiar
with red tide? It refers to the unusual discoloration (reddish-brown) of the seawater caused
by the uncontrolled growth of dinoflagellates. You always hear this during rainy season, after
a long, dry spell.
The study of the interactions of organisms with one another and with their physical
surroundings is called Ecology. The word ecology comes from the Greek word oikos which
means house and logos means study. So it means the study of the organism in a house.
The house referred to her is the environment in which organisms live, the interactions of
organisms with one another, and the interactions of organisms with the non-living
environment. Scientists who study ecology are called Ecologists.
Living things such as bacteria, fungi, protists, plants, and animals in the environment
are called biotic factors, while non-living things such as soil, water, temperature, air, light,
wind, moisture, and minerals are abiotic, these don’t have life. However, these factors may
determine the types of organisms that could thrive in a specific area. Most organisms live in
a place that is, for them the best place to live. Each species has adapted to a set of biotic
and abiotic factors of the environment. What may be limiting to one organism may not be
limiting to the others. Say for example, some bacteria can thrive at boiling–point
temperatures, while others will not survive.
. . that some organisms, mostly bacteria, can live in an environment at boiling point
temperature? They can be found in hot springs, mud springs, volcanic vents and fissures.
This is shocking, but true! They are called heat-loving bacteria or thermopiles.
In Ecology, the place where an organism lives is also called its habitat. Say for
example, if you want to look for a frog, you do not go to a desert but to wet and moist places
since frogs cannot survive in places that are hot and dry. Your surrounding is composed of
different types of habitat.
Ecological niche refers to the profession or role of an organism in the ecosystem.
Say for example if an organism is a bacterium one of its possible role or niche could be a
decomposer of organic matter in the ecosystem. A decomposer converts macromolecules to
simple molecules.
7
The deep portion of the ocean and all the other parts of the earth where life is found
make up the biosphere. The biosphere extends from the deepest part of the oceans to the
upper atmosphere and includes all the air, land and water where life exists. The biosphere
can be divided into three layers, the atmosphere (air), the hydrosphere (water), and the
lithosphere (land). All living things can be found within these three layers. Within this
biosphere, all living things depend upon and interact with each other and with the non-living
things of the environment.
. . that in the United States (Arizona) they have tried a very expensive experiment of
putting up Biosphere II patterned from planet earth? However, the experiment failed,
which suggests that making another biosphere on this planet is close to impossible.
There are also levels of organization in the ecology of the earth. An organism is an
individual living thing. For example, a single rabbit is an organism. A group of similar
organisms living in the same area forms a population. For instance, a population of rabbits
is composed of several rabbits and not only one. A group of different populations that live in
the same area and interact with each other form a community. A community maybe
composed of populations of rabbits, men, horses, mango trees, narra trees, etc.
Communities that interact with each other and with their physical environment form an
ecosystem. Finally, all the ecosystems of the earth form the total environment of the earth,
the biosphere. Are you now familiar with the increasing levels of organization in the study of
the environment?
Now that you are through with the first lesson, try to answer the following and see for
yourself how much you learned.
__________2. A group of different populations living in the same place and interacting with
each other.
8
__________3. The field of Science deals with the study of the interactions between the
living and the non-living components.
Did you encounter any problem? Compare your answers with the answer key and
see for yourself the items you missed. Good luck!
9
Lesson 2 . The Ecosystem
Let us begin by focusing on the smallest functional unit in Ecology known as the
ecosystem. An ecosystem consists of all the biotic and abiotic factors that surround
organisms and affect their way of life. Biotic factors are all the living organisms. Abiotic
factors include soil type, elevation, rainfall, temperature, humidity, light and location on
planet earth. It may be as large as the whole earth (the biosphere) a small part of it, such as
a river, a creek, or even a large boulder. Do you know that even a single decaying leaf can
be an ecosystem? A decaying log that you encounter as you walk through a forest can also
be considered an ecosystem.
10
What you will do
Activity 2.1
Studying an Ecosystem
Materials:
Procedure:
Analyze:
11
Did you enjoy the activity? You can do this in other ecosystems near your school or
home.
Take note that the living and the non-living components of an ecosystem are
inseparable from each other. They interact in order to form functional structures such as
nutrient cycling, energy flow, feeding relationship, biodiversity, stability, control, growth and
development. What is nutrient cycling? This term refers to the movement of nutrients
through the biosphere in a series of physical and biological processes. They are called
cycles because nutrients, unlike energy can be recycled over and over again by the living
systems.
In ecosystems, nutrients may become limited. The rate at which producers can
capture energy and use it to produce living tissue is controlled by several factors, one of
which is the amount of available nutrients. When nutrients are in short supply, it could limit
the growth of organisms - and so, it becomes a limiting factor. The presence of limiting
factors could interrupt the equilibrium in an ecosystem.
What is energy flow? Energy flow refers to the movement of energy through an
ecosystem from the sun to the producers and then to the consumers. For example, the
energy from the sun is used by the plants to perform photosynthesis, after which, this food
energy is used by the animals that will eat the plants. Energy flows through an ecosystem in
one direction, beginning with solar energy that photosynthetic organisms convert to
chemical energy.
Always remember that plants and animals in the biosphere are tied together in a
complicated network of feeding relationships. This maybe simple like the food chain, or a
bit complicated just like the food web. Food chain refers to a series of organisms through
which food energy is passed is an ecosystem. Say for example, palay (rice) is eaten by a
rat, and rat is eaten by the cat and the cat can be eaten by the snake. A food web is more
complicated it consists of several interlocking patterns of food chains. You can refer to the
next module for a more detailed discussion of these topics.
Biodiversity refers to the “variety and variability among living organisms including
the ecological complexes in which they occur”. You should always remember that
ecosystems are characterized by the presence of different organisms interacting with one
another. The more diverse the ecosystem, the more stable it is. It could easily adapt to the
different changes in the environmental conditions without drastic changes in the system.
Do not forget also that ecosystems grow and develop. It could start from a very
simple one and becomes more complicated and more diverse as it develops.
To make things easier for you, let us continue the discussion by using a pond as a
typical example of an ecosystem. Are there ponds in your place? I’m sure there are. Well,
this is one of the most common ecosystems especially in the province. So now get ready for
the journey!
12
The Pond Ecosystem
Try to look at Fig. 3 and examine carefully the components of a pond ecosystem.
Why is a pond considered an ecosystem? Can you enumerate the living and non-
living things in the picture? We have just discussed this in the last lesson. A pond
ecosystem is made up of the pond itself and all the plants, animals, protists, and bacteria
that live within it. The living components in a pond include plants, macroscopic and
microscopic plants (phytoplanktons), small animals like the larvae of many arthropods such
as insects and crustaceans (zooplanktons), snails, small and big fish, and many more. The
plants are of several types; some are rooted while others are floating. What may be
unknown to you is the presence of the microscopic groups of organisms such as bacteria,
molds and protists that make up a very important group of organisms in the pond. Have you
seen these organisms under the microscope? They are found in millions!
The abiotic components include the following: sunlight, water, gases, micronutrients,
macronutrients that are present in the pond. Temperature, salinity, and pH level are also
important.
All living things in the pond are affected by the matter and energy in the environment.
The primary source of energy in a pond is the sun. The energy flows from one organism to
another. The original energy from the sun may be stored by the plants after photosynthesis
in the form of chemical energy or food, or maybe used as energy for work. But, eventually,
all energy becomes heat and is lost into space. Thus, this ecosystem requires a constant
incoming supply of energy.
13
Unlike energy, materials in the pond can be recycled, thus, nutrients like phosphorus,
sulfur, nitrogen, and others undergo recycling.
Remember that ecosystems are open systems, which means that they exchange
matter and energy with their surroundings.
Before you move on to the next module, do answer the self-test and the posttest that
follow. Good luck!
Again, try to check how much you have learned from the lesson by answering the
following questions.
True or False. Write the word True if the statement is correct and False if it is
incorrect on the space provided before each number.
14
Let’s summarize
2. Ecology is the study of the relationships between organisms and their environment.
5. Biosphere refers to all the parts of the earth where life exists.
9. A community is a group of populations living in the same area and interacting with
each other.
10. An ecosystem is a community interacting with the abiotic parts of its environment.
11. An ecosystem need not be very big. It can be a single leaf, a rotting log, a creek or
any other smaller structures.
12. Energy flow refers to the transfer of energy from one organism to another.
13. Energy cannot be recycled. It only flows through the biosphere and is lost afterwards.
14. Nutrient cycling refers to the process of using and reusing of materials or nutrients.
15. Biodiversity refers to the “variety and variability among living organisms including
the ecological complexes in which they occur”.
17. Functional structures such as energy flow, nutrient cycling, growth and development,
biodiversity, and control exist in an ecosystem.
18. A pond ecosystem is made up of the pond itself and all the plants, animals, protists,
and bacteria that live within it.
15
19. The living components in a pond include the macroscopic plants and microscopic
phytoplanktons, small animals like the larvae of many arthropods such as insects and
crustaceans (zooplanktons), snails, small and big fish, and many more.
Post-test
I. Multiple Choice. Select the letter of the choice that answers the questions or completes
the statements
1. What do you call the study of the totality of the interactions of all the living and the
non-living components of the environment?
a. Environment
b. Ecology
c. Ecosystem
d. Earth
2. What refers to the plants, the birds, fungi and all those with life?
a. biotic
b. abiotic
c. biosphere
d. biology
3. Plants are the primary users of solar energy. This energy can be passed on from one
organism to the next in the process called
a. energy flow
b. photosynthesis
c. nutrient cycling
d. decomposition
4. The snakes, shrubs, termites, trees, and the birds comprise the:
a. niche
b. habitat
c. community
d. ecosystem
a. energy flow
16
b. food chain
c. food web
d. nutrient cycling
9. All of the following are functional structures that exist in an ecosystem. Which one
refers the variability among living organisms?
a. nutrient cycling
b. energy flow
c. decomposition
d. biodiversity
10. The ponds, lakes, deserts, and forests are examples of:
a. community
b. populations
c. ecosystem
d. organism
II. True or False. Write the word True if the statement is correct, and False if it is incorrect.
17
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. c
2. c
3. c
4. c
5. d
6. c
7. b
8. c
9. a
10.d
1. True
2. True
3. False
4. True
5. True
1. Biosphere
2. Community
3. Ecology
4. Population
5. Lithosphere
1. True
2. False
3. False
4. True
5. True
18
Post-test
1. b
2. a
3. a
4. c
5. b
6. c
7. b
8. d
9. d
10. c
11. False
12. False
13. True
14. True
15. True
-End of Module-
References
Lewis, R. (1998). Life 3rd Edition. USA: WCB Mc-Graw-Hill Co. Inc.
Mader, S. (1998). Biology 6th Edition. USA: WCB McGraw-Hill Co. Inc.USA.
Merril. (1994). Life Science. USA: Glencoe Division, Macmillan/McGraw-Hill Publishing Co. Oh., USA.
Wong, H. K., et.al.(1990). Biology: The key ideas. Englewoods, NJ: Prentice Hall, Inc.
19
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 10
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 10
Can We Live Alone?
You have just finished the module regarding the environment and the ecosystem. Did
you enjoy it? If so, that’s good! In This module you will learn more about the ecosystem. If
you recall, the ecosystem has functional structures that were not discussed in detail in the
last module. Now is your chance to be more familiar with these topics.
2
How to learn from this module?
In order to achieve the objectives of this module successfully, you have to remember
the following:
1. A feeding relationship that proceeds from algae to fish, to a fisherman, and finally to a
shark is best described as:
3
4. Which of the following is a primary producer?
a. dilis
b. seaweed
c. shark
d. whale
a. autotrophs
b. primary consumers
c. secondary consumers
d. tertiary consumers
6. Which of the following gasses is more or less 79% of the atmospheric gas?
a. argon
b. nitrogen
c. oxygen
d. sulfur
a. food chain
b. food web
c. photosynthesis
d. trophic level
a. accumulation
b. condensation
c. evaporation
d. precipitation
9. Which is a type of pyramid that represents the total number of organisms involved?
a. food pyramid
b. pyramid of biomass
c. pyramid of energy
d. pyramid of number
10. Organisms that feed both on plants and animals are called:
a. carnivores
b. detritivores
4
c. herbivores
d. omnivores
II. Classify the Following. Classify the following animals as producer, herbivore, carnivore
or omnivore by placing them in the right column.
III. Consider this food web of organisms in the ocean given below:
stingray
A. How many food chains can you identify from the food web?
B. Write them as separate food chains.
C. What will happen if a larvae is removed from the food web?
seaweeds dilis
lapu-lapu shark
V. Give the type of relationship that exists between the following organisms.
5
Lesson 1 Biotic Relationships
Have you ever imagined life without your neighbors? Life could be very incomplete
and boring. It is the interactions that you do with your neighbors that give life to your
everyday activities. Organisms interact with one another in many ways. The relationships
may benefit one and harm the other, benefit both or harm both. When organisms live in
close association with one another, they are said to have a symbiotic relationship.
Examine the diagram below. Have you ever seen this underwater? Well, if you live
close to the sea, you must be familiar with this. Do you know of any relationship that exists
between the organisms in this picture?
This picture shows the presence of corals and algae. Are you familiar with algae?
They are commonly called as seaweeds. They belong to kingdom Protista, and are
photosynthetic. In this type of relationship, the corals provide shelter for the algae that lives
on the body of the polyps. The algae in return, give nourishment to the corals. This type of
symbiotic relationship is called mutualism. Individuals in this relationship all benefit from the
association established. There is a close association with each other.
The picture next page shows a diagram of a leech sucking blood on the arm of man.
Have you seen one like this before? Were you afraid? In the province it is common to see
leeches attached to the skin of carabaos, cows and other animals.
Do you know the type of relationship that exists between the leech and the man in the
picture? Which one is the parasite? Which one is the host? A parasite is an organism that
depends on the host for food. In this case, which one is the parasite? Why do you say so? If
your answer is leech you are right! Leeches are ectoparasites that depend on the host’s
blood for food. They produce an anticoagulant called hirudin that prevents clotting while
blood is being sucked. In this case, man is the host and is harmed. The harm to the host
maybe extreme or only slight.
6
Parasitism
Examine the next diagram. What do you see? Have you been to a place with this
type of trees/plants? If you have experienced taking a walk in a forest, you must be familiar
with this. The plant in the diagram is locally known as the bird’s nest. It usually grows
among the trunks of trees in thick forests. You will observe that many big trees are hosts to
smaller plants like ferns, mosses and the like.
The type of relationship that exists between the ferns (or other plants) and the tree is
called commensalism. The tree provides the support to the ferns, but it does not gain or lose
anything. In this type of relationship, one individual benefits from the other without causing
any harm to it.
Can you suggest other examples of this type of relationships? Have you seen a blue
crab with a sea anemone on its back? This is also another example of commensalism. Here,
the crab is the host and the guest is the sea anemone. In this case, the sea anemone gets a
free ride from the crab and free food! Sea anemones are attached to a substrate and they
are not mobile. This time, they get a free ride from the crab which moves from one place to
another. Some scraps of food from the crab may also reach the sea anemone at the back.
7
The crab is neither harmed nor benefited in this case. This relationship is shown in the
picture below.
Predation
Take a look at the picture below. Can you predict what will happen next?
8
I’m sure the diagram below is familiar to you. This is common even in your front and
backyards. You see many plants live together. Can you imagine how they compete for food?
When organisms compete for the same resources, the association is called
competition. For example, grasses may compete with other garden plants such as
eggplant, palay, and onions, for the nutrients in the soil. This competition results to the
depletion of the resources.
The barracuda and the shark may also compete for the same food such as the small
fishes, and this is another example of competition. Competition is an example of a biotic
relationship that is common among many biotic members of the ecosystem. Can you cite
other examples of competition?
Amensalism
Do you know that there are organisms that may live together only for sometime
because one species secrete a toxic or lethal substance that could kill the other species?
Are you familiar with some of them? A certain species of Artemisia (damong maria) secrete
a substance that can kill the grasses that may grow around them. This is an example of
amensalism.
It has been found in laboratories that bacteria cannot be grown mixed with other
species of fungi or mold which in this case emit substances that are lethal to the bacteria.
Look at the diagram below. This is an example of a bacterial culture with fungi. The
two may live together for sometime. However, if the fungi will secrete toxic substances,
eventually, no bacteria will survive and only the fungi will remain. This is called allelopathy.
It involves the production and release of chemical substances by one species that inhibit the
growth of another. Allelopathic substances range from acids to bases to simple organic
compounds.
9
An example of Allelopathy
Neutralism
This is the last biotic relationship that will be discussed. It is the most common type
of interspecific interaction. This is an interaction involving two different species. Neither
population directly affects the other. The interactions that occur are slight and indirect. The
simple presence of the two species should not directly affect the population level of either
species. An example of neutralism would be the interaction between yourself and the cats.
10
A. From this drawing, enumerate as many relationships as you can derive and give the
particular organisms involved in each relationship.
Questions:
C. Gather pictures of the different biotic relationships and make a collage out of them. A
collage is any artistic composition / representation of any subject matter.
11
Lesson 2 Energy Flow in the Ecosystem
Food Chains
Are you familiar with a food chain? Why do you think is it called a chain? Chain would
simply mean connection or connectivity of one to the other. Are you a member of the food
chain? Well, all of us are members of the food chain. We all belong to the same trophic
level. As members of the food chain, you should know more about it. Get ready and start to
explore what it is.
Green plants are the only organisms that make their own food. Animals that eat
green plants make the next link to the chain. Other animals often eat them. This sequence
of eating and being eaten is called a food chain. Each organism is a link in the food chain.
When plants and animals die, they become food for scavengers and decomposers such as
the bacteria and fungi that in turn are responsible for the organisms’ decay and cause the
minerals to return to the soil.
Examine these two diagrams: The first diagram (1) shows the interaction between the
grass and the worm. The arrow points from the producer (grass) to the consumers (worm).
The worm eats the grass or the worm feeds on the grass.
1. Grass Worm
The second diagram (2) shows the additional box for the chicken. This shows that the
chicken feeds on the worm. This is another example of a food chain. Below is another
example of a food chain with a diagram
Birds are not the only consumers that feed on plant seeds. Mice and other rodents
also feed on them. Snakes like the python feed on mice. Plant seeds, mouse, and snake
form another food chain.
12
Is everything clear? I hope so. Now get ready for a new topic, a topic that is related to
food chain - the food web. Get set go!
Food Web
Examine the diagram below. How many food chains can be derived from the
illustration? There are several of them.
Write on a piece of paper the food chains that you can see in the diagram. How do
food chains differ from food web? The diagram appears to be more complicated than a food
chain. A food web is a series of interrelated food chains which provides a more accurate
picture of the feeding relationships in an ecosystem, as more than one organism will usually
eat a particular species or food. Therefore, food chains can overlap, cross or interlock
forming a network. Do not be confused with the arrows. Just follow where the arrow
originates and it will tell you which one eats what. For example, many organisms such as
mice, worm, frog and the birds. From these primary consumers will feed different secondary
consumers, and from these different secondary consumers will feed different tertiary
consumers forming an interlocking pattern.
Now, on your own, construct a food web using the diagram below.
13
What you will do
Activity 2.1
Below are some pictures of organisms that can be connected into a food web. See if you
can decide how to connect the pictures to show the energy flow correctly! Good luck!
Did you find the activity enjoyable? I’m sure you did! Congratulations and more power!
14
1 k cal.
10 k cal.
100 k cal.
An Energy Pyramid
Notice that there are more producers than herbivores, and many more herbivores
than carnivores. Why do you think this is so? It appears that less energy is available at each
level of the pyramid as you move towards the top. Only about 10% of the energy in the
grass seed is available to the rabbits and only 10% of energy stored in the rabbits are
available to the lion, and so. This means that the animals at the top of the pyramid depend
on very large populations of producers and herbivores to stay alive. Don’t forget that less
energy is available at each level of the pyramid as you move toward the top.
In the three topics - food chain, food web, and energy pyramid are related to each
other since energy is involved. These relationships are based on the flow of energy that is
transferred from one organism to the next.
15
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
5. Which among these organisms will receive the least amount of energy?
a. bird c. caterpillar
b. plants d. grasshoppers
16
Lesson 3 Cycles of Matter
You already learned the importance of the biotic components and their interactions
and interrelationships in an ecosystem. Energy is needed for the organisms to survive.
Organisms need food in order to live. Aside from food, other substances must be present in
the ecosystem for organisms to function properly. There are four elements required:
hydrogen, oxygen, carbon dioxide and nitrogen. These elements should continuously be
recycled within an ecosystem to sustain life.
Looking at the picture, plants use carbon dioxide in the air together with water and
other elements from the soil plus solar energy to manufacture their own food. The process is
called photosynthesis. As a result of the process, plants produce glucose (starch) as
stored food, and oxygen as a by-product. In respiration, consumers eat some of this stored
food, and inhale oxygen. They transform and use this food to obtain energy and release
carbon dioxide as a by-product. Carbon dioxide may also come from fossil fuels like those
seen in the diagram. The release of carbon dioxide into the atmosphere during respiration
completes the carbon dioxide – oxygen cycle.
17
The Water Cycle
Water moves from the atmosphere to the surface and back to the atmosphere in a
process called the water cycle. When heavy clouds form, starts to change from a gaseous
state to liquid form through a process called condensation. Water falls from the
atmosphere to the earth through precipitation in the form of rain, drizzle, hail or snow. It
goes back to the atmosphere through evaporation, when some of the water on the surface
becomes gas. Some of the water that falls to the earth reaches the ground and as run off
water, it travels to become part of a lake, river or ocean. Some water may also come out
from the body of plants and animals in the process called transpiration. Some of the water
goes deep underground and becomes ground water. Underground water also finds its way
to lakes and rivers and eventually joins the oceans where evaporation takes place,
completing the water cycle.
Water Cycle
Nitrogen is the most abundant element in the atmosphere, making up 79% of it. But
free nitrogen must first be converted into nitrates before plants can use them. The process
by which nitrogen passes from the atmosphere to the organisms and back is called the
nitrogen cycle. During a thunderstorm, nitrogen is converted into nitrates by lightning. The
process of converting atmospheric nitrogen into compounds such as ammonia, nitrites or
nitrates by natural processes is called nitrogen fixation. These nitrates are brought to the
ground during precipitation and are then absorbed and used by plants.
Nitrogen can also be converted into nitrates directly from the air.
18
Nitrogen Cycle
This is done by nitrogen-fixing bacteria, which are found in the leguminous plants.
Examples of these legumes are mongo, beans, peanuts, and peas.
Dead and decaying matter contain nitrogen, which is converted into ammonia by
bacteria. This process is called ammonification. Other bacteria oxidize the ammonia to
form nitrites. Eventually, other bacteria change the nitrates to ammonia to form nitrites. This
process of converting ammonia and nitrites into nitrates is called nitrification.
Some organisms, called denitrifying bacteria, convert nitrates, and ammonia in the
soil and decaying matter back into free nitrogen. This process is called denitrification. The
free nitrogen is then released into the atmosphere and the cycle continues.
Phosphorus Cycle
Another cycle that you have to be familiar with is the phosphorus cycle. Where do
phosphates come from? Initially, phosphate weathers from rocks. The small losses in a
terrestrial system caused by leaching through the action of rain are balanced in the gains
from weathering rocks. In soil, phosphate is absorbed on clay surfaces and organic matter
particles and becomes incorporated (immobilized). Plants dissolve ionized forms of
phosphate. Herbivores obtain phosphorus by eating plants, and carnivores by eating
herbivores. Herbivores and carnivores excrete phosphorus as a waste product in urine and
feces. Phosphorus is released back to the soil when plants or animal matter decomposes
and the cycle repeats.
Another pathway of phosphorus cycle occurs when phosphorus moves from land to
sediments in the seas and then back to land again. The main storage for phosphorus is in
the earth’s crust. On land, phosphorus is usually found in the form of phosphates. By the
19
process of weathering and erosion phosphates enter rivers and streams that transport them
to the ocean. Once in the ocean the phosphorus accumulates on continental shelves in the
form of insoluble deposits. After millions of years, the crustal plates rise from the sea floor
and expose the phosphates on land. After more time, weathering will release them from rock
and the cycle's geochemical phase begins again.
1. Which of the following would you consider as the main reservoir of water?
a. rivers c. atmosphere
b. ocean d. soil
20
4. Nitrogen is ______% of the atmospheric gas.
a. 79% c. 69%
b. 99% d. 89%
a. Plants c. rocks
b. Animals d. sun
7. The process whereby water is converted from a gaseous state to a liquid state is
called
a. pecipitation c. condensation
b. evaporation d. sublimation
a. nitrification
b. evaporation
c. denitrification
d. ammonification
a. water
b. stones
c. animals
d. sun
21
Let’s summarize
1. Organisms may form close associations with one another. Such associations
may occur between individuals of the same species (intraspecific) or between
individuals of different species (interspecific).
2. Parasitism is an association between two organisms in which one, the parasite,
lives temporarily or permanently in or on the other, the host, deriving benefit from
it and causing harm to it.
3. Commensalism is an association between two organisms, where a commensal
gains while the host neither loses nor gains.
4. Mutualism is an association that is mutually beneficial to both participants. This is
one of the common associations between organisms.
5. Energy cannot be recycled. Only matter can be recycled.
6. Energy moves in one direction. A food chain is the pathway that matter and
energy take as they are transferred from one feeding level to the next.
7. The pattern of food chains that interlock and form a network is called a food web.
8. There are advantages of living in a complex food web where there are several
sources of food.
9. An energy pyramid is a diagram that explains the energy flow from one feeding
level to another.
10. Living things are related to each other by their food relationships. These
relationships are based on the flow of energy that is transferred from one
organism to the next.
11. The biosphere is a closed system.
12. Recycling is the using and reusing of materials. The water, minerals, oxygen,
nitrogen, carbon and other chemicals necessary for life in the biosphere must be
recycled again and again for life to continue.
13. The processes of photosynthesis and respiration recycle carbon and oxygen
14. Bacteria aid in the recycling of nitrogen.
15. The three most important cycles needed for life are water cycle, carbon-oxygen
cycle, and nitrogen cycle.
16. Water cycle is the movement of water from the atmosphere to the lithosphere
and hydrosphere and then back to the atmosphere.
22
Posttest
1. Which of the following gasses is more or less 79% of the atmospheric gas?
a. argon
b. nitrogen
c. oxygen
d. sulfur
4. What do you call a type of pyramid that represents the total number of organisms
involved?
a. food pyramid
b. pyramid of biomass
c. pyramid of energy
d. pyramid of number
6. A feeding relationship that proceeds from algae to fish, then to a fisherman and finally
to a shark is best described as:
a. food chain
b. food web
c. predation
d. a and c above
23
7. Trophic levels can be described as:
a. hierarchy of energy transfers
b. structured feeding relationships
c. who eats who
d. any one of the above descriptions is appropriate
II. Classify the following. Given the following animals below, classify them as
producer, herbivore, carnivore or omnivore by placing them in the right column.
24
III. Consider the following organisms in the ocean.
a. How many food chains can you identify from the food web?
b. Write them as separate food chains.
c. What will happen if the small fish is removed from the food web?
seaweeds dilis
lapu-lapu shark
V. Give the type of relationship that exists between the following organisms.
25
Key to answers
Pretest
I.
1. b
2. d
3. b
4. c
5. b
6. c
7. b
8. d
9. b
10. d
II.
III.
A. 3
B.
1. seaweeds anchovy trout fish
2. seaweeds larvae swordfish
3. seaweeds larvae stingray
C.
1. Two of the food chains will be disturbed since the food supply for the swordfish
and stingray will decrease.
26
IV. Food Pyramid
V.
a. commensalism
b. mutualism
c. predation
d. mutualism
e. parasitism
Self-Test 1.1
A.
Association Organism A Organism B
1. predation lion zebra
2. predation bird worm
3. mutualism ants tree
4. mutualism man plants
5. commensalism tree orchid
27
B.
1. Predation
2. Because the bird (predator) attacked the worm directly. They are bigger and more
powerful than the worms.
3. “The early bird catches the early worm”
Activity 2.1
Self-Test 2.1
1. d
2. d
3. a
4. c
5. a
28
Self-Test 3.1
1. b
2. b
3. b
4. a
5. c
6. c
7. a
8. c
9. c
10. b
Posttest
I.
1. c
2. a
3. a
4. b
5. b
6. a
7. d
8. c
9. d
10. d
II.
III.
A. 3
B.
1. aquatic plants larvae crab
2. aquatic plants small fish trout fish
3. aquatic plants small fish blue marlin
29
C.
1. Two of the food chains will be disturbed since the food supply for the big fishes
will decrease.
IV.
V.
a. commensalism
b. mutualism
c. predation
d. mutualism
e. parasitism
References
Roberts, M. V. B. (1985). Biology: A functional approach. Turin. Italy: G. Canale and C. S. P. A.
Wong, H.K. & Dolmatz, M.S. (1983). Biology: The key ideas. Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey: Prentice-Hall,
Inc.,
Starr, C. & Laggart, R. (1992). Biology: The unity and diversity of life. Belmont, California: Wadsworth
Publishing Company.
30
De Vera, M.P. Science fundamentals for high school I, Integrated Science. Manila: Trinitas Publishing, Inc.
Bureau of Secondary Education (1989). Science and technology I, First Year H.S. Manila.
Cruz, J. (2000). Science and technology II for the modern world. Diwa Manila: Publishing P
31
32
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 11
Pasig City
1
Module 11
Earth’s Resources
Where do we get food, water, air and other necessities? We get it from the many
natural resources deposited/present in our abode. In this module we shall learn the
following lessons:
2
How to learn from this module
1. Read the instructions carefully.
2. Take the pretest before reading the rest of the module.
3. Do all the activities and exercises.
4. Use the concept discussed in each lesson to explain the results of activities or
exercises.
5. Take the posttest after you have finished the lessons and performed all
activities or exercises.
Direction: Select the letter of the word/group of words that best answers the question.
1. A natural resource is any material or element from the environment that humans
a. have not created
b. observe scientifically
c. make for themselves
d. use to meet their needs
2. A resource that people can use again and again without destroying it is called
a. renewable
b. unlimited
c. non-renewable
d. potentially renewable
3. The resource base varies in different parts of the world because resources are not
a. sufficient to meet the needs of developed countries
b. needed in the same amounts by all people
c. taken from both land and water in all countries
d. evenly distributed on the earth
3
5. When heavy rains drain off nutrients from the soil, the soil is said to have become
a. barren
b. fertile
c. sandy
d. leached
9. Which of the following metal/minerals is used to make electrical wires, hardware, and
pipes?
a. bauxite
b. copper
c. gold
d. tin
4
12. Which of the following practices makes soil infertile?
a. use of fertilizer
b. green manufacturing
c. extensive agriculture
d. use of compost matter
Before you start with the lessons in this module, familiarize yourself with the terms
listed in Table 1:
5
Phtyoremediation Removing pollutants from soil and
water with the use of plants
Wastewater treatment Technology to remove wastes from
wastewater of industries and dirty
bodies of freshwater
Water purification Process of making potable water from
surface water /groundwater for human
consumption
You often hear it said that the Philippines is rich in terms of resources. What is a
resource? We can look at it in two ways.
2. Economic resource
1. Ecological resource - is anything obtained from
- is anything required by the environment to meet your
organisms like you for needs and wants. Examples
normal maintenance, are food, water, shelter,
growth and reproduction. manufactured goods,
Examples are water, transportation,
shelter, food, and communication and
habitat. recreation.
6
You can see these resources in Fig. 1.1
Solar capital
( 99 % of the
earth’s capital)
Climate
Air control Recycling vital
resources chemicals such
as carbon,
oxygen,
Water
resources Renewable
resources
Natural capital
Soil (life support
formation and economic
services Non-
and renewal renewable
resources
Wastes
removal and Potentially
detoxification renewable
resources such
as wood,
Natural pest widlife
and control
biodiversity
7
Based on the short human time scale, natural resources are classified into three
categories. Table 1.1 lists the three categories of natural resources.
We have a lot of resources to meet our needs. Some of these resources are finite.
Other resources are renewable but it takes time to replace or replenish them. Unfortunately,
the rapid consumption of these raw materials by our expanding population has led to the
exploitation of the natural resources. Exploitative attitudes of humans rapidly reduce the
availability of natural resources.
1. Make a poster about the state of the different resources in your place that are
needed for survival.
a. Does the poster you make mirror available resources to you and your
family?
b. Which resources are not available? Why?
c. As a person with needs and wants, how can you stop the depletion of the
resources in your place?
8
Your answer in 1.c brings us to the question,” Are we going to use these depleting
resources or not? As mentioned in lesson 1, we depend a lot on the natural resources to
meet our needs and wants. We can not afford to lose any of the earth’s resources as our
survival depends on them. There is then a need to safeguard them. We can safeguard
these resources through conservation.
Conservation means not to use any of the natural resources but to utilize, manage
and preserve our natural resources properly. It requires wise use of natural resources.
When using these resources, we need to make sure that the environment is not damaged in
the process. The aims of conservation include the following:
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the question.
2. A resource that is destroyed when used, but can be replaced is said to be:
a recyclable c renewable
b nonrenewable d. potentially renewable
3. Which of the following does not belong to the natural capital/natural resource?
a. air b. land c. water d. energy from the sun
9
Lesson 2 The Earth’s Freshwater Source
Water is important to all of us. Each of us drinks about 1.5 liters of water everyday.
We depend on its good quality and quantity for drinking, cooking, cleaning , recreation, use
in industry and growing crops. It is also vital to sustaining the natural systems on and under
the earth's surface. Below are sources of the earth’s freshwater.
Polar caps are frozen water formed in cold areas such as in high mountains and in
the polar regions. These polar caps contain 2 % of the available freshwater on earth. This is
the earth’s water reserve. Scientists are trying to develop ways of sourcing freshwater from
polar caps.
The water you get through a water pump is called groundwater. Groundwater is the
water that fills the tiny spaces between alluvial material (sand, gravel, silt, clay) or the
crevices or fractures in rocks. It is a hidden resource. It accounts for more than 95 % of all
available freshwater for use. Nearly 95% of rural residents rely on groundwater for drinking
supply and for washing soiled clothes. Irrigated croplands use groundwater. Groundwater is
also used for industries.
10
groundwater over time. Road salt, toxic substances from mining sites, and used motor oil
also contaminate groundwater. Drinking contaminated groundwater can have serious health
effects. Diseases such as hepatitis and dysentery may be caused by contamination from
septic tank waste. Poisoning may be caused by toxins that have leaked into well water
supplies. Wildlife can also be harmed by contaminated groundwater. Other long term effects
such as certain types of cancer may also result from exposure to polluted water.
Over extraction of groundwater can lead to lowered water table. Thus, the water table
often dries up during summer. Ground subsidence may also occur.
Sources of surface water such as a river are more accessible than ground water. The
Philippines has many rivers, lakes, ponds, streams and creeks. Watersheds provide much
of our freshwater supply.
A place may also adopt a storage reservoir by building dams. Most dams are built to
prevent flooding. A good example of a dam that counteracts water shortage is the
Pantabangan Dam in Bulacan.
11
The distribution of surface water source is not uniform. Some places have more of it
while others have less. Thus, surface water is transferred from one basin to another through
pipelines, reservoirs, canals or aqueduct. However the transfer of water from one place to
another presents problems to water supplies. Below are some problems due to excessive
water transfer.
Freshwater from surface water is not used immediately as potable or drinking water.
It has to undergo purification in filter plants for it to be fit for drinking. A good example of
filter plant is the Balara Filter Plant in Balara, Diliman, Quezon City. The water is carried by
huge pipes from La Mesa Dam. The water is screened to remove suspended particles.
Aluminum sulfate and calcium oxide are mixed with water. The mixture is added as soon as
water enters the plant. A gelatinous substance, aluminum hydroxide, is formed. The tiny
particles in water aggregate with the gelatinous aluminum hydroxide to form big particles. In
the sedimentation ponds, the aggregates settle to the bottom. The water is passed through
a filter bed with grains of sands and activated carbon. To remove microorganisms, chlorine
gas is added to water to produce hydrochloric acid and hypochlorous acid. Hydrochloric acid
kills the microorganisms while hypochlorous acid bleaches the water. The disinfected water
may be aerated by spraying it into air prior to distribution to different households and
establishments. The entire technology is shown in Fig. 2.
Many bodies of freshwater in the country are polluted. Why? When we farm lands
beside these bodies of water, fertilizers and other farm inputs seep into them when it rains.
Also, Filipinos grow pigs and ducks near freshwater sources so wastes are emptied into
12
these water sources. We use bodies of freshwater as dumping grounds of domestic,
agricultural and industrial wastes.
There is a need to rehabilitate major rivers and lakes by removing debris and other
waste materials. An example of a rehabilitation program the government has created is the
Laguna Lake Development Authority (LLDA) for Laguna de Bay alone. There is also a
rehabilitation program for the Pasig River.
Many industries generate waste water. Some companies such as the subsidiaries of
the San Miguel Corporation put up wastewater treatment plants. Each has its own
wastewater treatment facility. We shall talk about the different steps in cleaning wastewater.
Solid debris such as wood, rocks, dead animals and other solids pass through a
series of screens of different mesh. These debris are grated or separated. Treatment
equipment such as bar screens, comminutors (a large version of a garbage disposal), and
grit chambers are used as the wastewater first enters a treatment plant. Once reduced to
pieces, it is sent to a landfill.
Primary Treatment
Primary treatment is the second step. It removes suspended solids and grease from
wastewater. This is done by keeping wastewater in a quiet tank for several hours to allow
suspended particles to settle to the bottom and the greases to float to the top. The solids
drawn off the bottom and skimmed off the top receive further treatment as sludge. The
clarified wastewater flows on to the next stage of wastewater treatment. Clarifiers and septic
tanks are some of the equipment at this stage.
Secondary Treatment
13
1. Fixed Film Systems
In this system, microorganisms are grown in rocks, sand or plastic. The wastewater is
spread over the rocks, sands and plastics with microorganisms. As organic matter and
nutrients are absorbed from the wastewater, the film of microorganisms grows and thickens.
Trickling filters, rotating biological contactors, and sand filters are examples of fixed film
systems.
3. Lagoon Systems
Lagoon systems are shallow basins which hold the wastewater for several months to
allow for the natural degradation of sewage. These systems take advantage of natural
aeration and microorganisms in the wastewater to remove sewage.
Final Treatment
Disease-causing organisms are removed from wastewater during the final treatment.
This is done by adding chlorine or by using ultraviolet light. Too much chlorine harms
aquatic life in receiving streams. Thus, chlorine-neutralizing chemical is added to the
treated wastewater before stream discharge.
The entire process of cleaning wastewater from factories, dirty bodies of water like
Pasig River and Septic Tank for domestic use is summarized in Fig. 3.1
14
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the questions or
completes the statements.
15
Lesson 3 Marine Water
We live in a country with 7100 islands. Thus, we have enough marine resources.
These resources include the coastal areas where mangroves, seagrass communities, beach
forest and coral reefs are found. They provide habitats for many marine organisms such as
algae, mollusks, fishes and crustaceans. These organisms are used by man for food.
Beaches are also popular recreational areas.
Marine water is very salty. Let us do Activity 3.1 to find out how much salt is present
in marine water.
What to do:
What you have obtained when you heated seawater to dryness was a white residue.
It is the salt that we use with our food. The salt in marine water is about thirty five percent
(35%). Thus, we can not drink seawater without removing the salt. If this salt is removed,
the water becomes a potable water. How can we remove the salt?
16
Fig. 3.1 A desalinating plant ( Photo credited to http://nett21.unep.or.jp/)
There are different ways to desalinate salt water. One is through rapid spray
evaporation (RSE). RSE ejects the salt water through a nozzle into a stream of heated air,
forming a mist of droplets which vaporize almost instantly. Solid flakes of salt fall to the
bottom of the container during the process and can be collected.
The coastlines of the Philippines measure 34600 km. More than half of the Filipinos
live near coastal areas. They depend on fishing for their livelihood. However, over-fishing,
compounded with dynamite, cyanide and moro ami fishing, has caused marine resources
to decrease rapidly. Marine life has also been adversely affected by oil spills from
motorboats or tankers and debris made of plastics from beach resorts.
Marine waters are contaminated with all kinds of pollutants. Garbage dumped into
the ground and rivers all end up in the sea. You can even find plastic in Sargasso Sea, a
sea very far from human dwelling places.
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the question.
a. By distillation c. By filtration
b. By evaporation d. By desalination
c.
17
2. Which of the following degrades the quality of water?
a. moro ami fishing
b. cyanide fishing
c. dynamite fishing
d. all of the above.
e.
3. We use marine water as
a. food source
b. means of transportation
c. means of recreation
d. all of the above
Land is teeming with life of myriad forms. A hectare of soil may contain at least 300
million invertebrates – mites, millipedes, insects, worms, and other tiny creatures. About 30
grams of soil may contain one million bacteria, 100,000 yeast cells and 50,000 fungus
mycelium. Without these microorganisms, soil could not convert nitrogen, phosphorus, and
sulfur to forms useful to plants.
Soil can support multitude of life forms which in turn enable it to support plants.
Through constant self-reinforcing forces, the soil becomes enriched with dead organic
matter that helps make soil fertile. Soil also contains water. We shall do Activity 4.1 to
approximate the absorption rate of your soil .
What to do:
1. Cut the top and bottom from a can.
2. Hammer the can halfway into the ground you want to test.
3. Pour a specified amount of water into the can that is in the ground. The amount of water
should not overflow the top of the can and you should be able to pour all of it into the can
at one time.
4. With a stopwatch determine the number of seconds that elapse until the water is
absorbed into the soil.
5. Divide the number of seconds by the number of ounces to get a rate in ounces per
second.
Some soil have difficulty absorbing water. Such soil is not good for living things on
land. Some soils cannot water long enough. The soil is also not good for planting crops. But
18
there are soils such garden soil can hold enough water for plants and other land creatures. It
is this soil useful to farmers.
This natural resource is renewable but difficult to replace. Why? As learned in module
12, it takes time to form soil. One third of the earth’s surface is covered by land, amounting
to about 32 billion acres. Not all land is useful to man. Most are mountainous and rocky.
Deserts do not have enough water to support crops. Snow-covered land cannot be used for
farming.
What are the uses of land and soil? We build towns and cities to house the ballooning
human population. We need land for industry and agriculture. Through agriculture, we are
able to feed the growing number of humankind.
Huge tracks of land are also used in growing animals that are sources of food for
man. These animals include chicken, pigs, cows, goat, sheep, and carabao. These animals
have to be fed. So, we need lands to plant vegetation to feed them.
Despite the importance of land and soil to man, we degrade the quality of soil is lost
or degraded through:
Soil erosion can be avoided or reduced in many ways. These practices include the
following:
Alley farming or
agroforestry is a form of Windbreaks or Gullies created by
intercropping in which shelterbreaks are long water runoff can be
several crops are planted rows of trees are reclaim by planting
together in strips or alleys planted to partially quick-growing
between trees and shrubs block the wind. shrubs, vines and
that can provide fruit or trees.
fuelwood.
19
Fertile soil is also lost through conversion of prime agricultural lands into urban and
suburban development such as subdivisions. Filipinos should consider high rise dwelling
places instead of single detached housing to reduce conversion of arable lands to
subdivisions.
We throw cans, bottles, paper, plastics, and other objects into the ground. Some of
these particles/objects are not biodegradable. Would you like to know how much garbage
each of us produce everyday which we may dump into the ground? Let us do Activity 4.1
1. It is Monday and you are leaving home. Bring a bag with you.
2. Into this bag, put all the solid wastes you produce the whole day
3. Once home, weigh the bag full of garbage. How much garbage did you
accumulate the whole day?
4. If there are ten of you in the family, how many kilos of garbage does your family
produce in a week?
Many farmers use agrochemical farm inputs. Examples of agrochemical farm inputs
are synthetic chemical fertilizers and pesticides. These farm inputs also destroy soil. Why?
20
Since pest can not be avoided, farmers should consider Integrated Pest Management
(IPM). You can start this technique by knowing the pest and their natural enemies. By doing
so, effective and environment-friendly insect management control program can be designed.
To maximize the potential of land and soil for agriculture, new crops were developed,
better farming techniques were designed, unfertile soil was made fertile and many more.
One way to increase productivity of soil is through irrigation, which waters dry land. Thus,
barren deserts are now productive. Crop rotation could help improve soil fertility. Farmers
may use composted agricultural wastes and unprocessed crushed rocks containing
potassium and phosphate ions. Green manure (fresh or growing green vegetables) is
plowed into the soil to increase organic matter.
Finally, denuded forest should be reforested. If you live beside an empty lot, plant a
tree – fruit-bearing tree like mango and avocado, gmelina, neem tree, madre de cacao, ipil-
ipil, and other trees that do not require much care. When these trees are fully grown, their
roots can hold water and soil. It can also remove carbon dioxide and other gaseous
pollutants. It also provides homes to tree-dwelling animals.
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the question.
2. Which of the following practices is the best way to improve soil fertility?
a. Apply synthetic chemical fertilizer.
b. Use composted agricultural wastes.
c. Use burnt agricultural wastes.
d. all of the above
21
d. b and c
What to do:
1. Look at the ears, neck, fingers, wrists head of all members of the family? What do
they have in these body parts?
2. Get the purse of the family members. What do you find in the purse?
3. Go the kitchen. You will find utensils and pots.
From steps 1 to 3, you will find metals used as jewelries, coins, utensils and cooking
pots. Where do these metals come from? The come from metallic mineral ores.
Metallic mineral ores contain iron, aluminum and copper, which are important to
construction industry. The same is true with non-metallic minerals such as quartz. Table 5.1
shows these important minerals to industries.
22
Minerals are removed from rocks through mining. Mining companies use the
following methods to identify promising mineral deposits:
Once mineral deposits are identified, there are several ways to obtain them. These
are:
Mining is one of humankind’s oldest activities but the techniques used to extract
minerals have not changed substantially for centuries. Ores are dug from the earth,
crushed, then minerals such as copper and gold are extracted by extreme heat or toxic
chemicals. Extraction can be done physically, chemically or both. The purified minerals are
sent to manufacturing plants to be made into final products such as galvanized iron. Each
step has an effect on the environment and our health. The following boxes show the effects
of mining, extraction, and utilization of substances from ores.
23
The environmental and health effects of traditional mining technologies have been
harmful. The following alternatives had been identified.
Biomining
Now, the mining industries have turned to microorganisms to separate minerals from
ores. This method of extraction, termed biomining, is more efficient and environment
friendly. Using a bacterium such as Thiobacillus ferooxidans, to separate copper from rocks
or mine tailings have improved recovery rates and reduced operating costs. Moreover, it
allows extraction from low grade ores, an important consideration in the midst of depletion of
high grade ores.
How does the bacterium extract the minerals from rocks? Poor quality metal ore such
as copper sulfide and iron sulfide is dumped outside a mine and treated with sulfuric acid to
encourage growth of Thiobacillus ferooxidans which can be obtained from sulfur-containing
materials. The bacterium gets energy by oxidizing inorganic materials. The process
releases copper or iron and the metal is collected from the solution. The sulfuric acid is
recycled.
About ½ of the iron requirement of steel industry comes from scrap. About 1/3 of
aluminum needs of some industries comes from recycled cans. Recycling iron and
aluminum brings energy savings. The energy required to produce one ton of secondary
aluminum from scrap is only 5 % of the energy required to extract and purify primary
aluminum from ore. Scrap is now a vital source of supply for metals.
Many products are packed in cans. Almost everybody patronize these products at
home, restaurants and canteens. Instead of throwing away aluminum cans of soft drinks, tin
cans and iron-containing cans, we can recycle them. Let us have can drive campus wide so
as rusty metals lying some corners at home
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the question.
24
2. Where do we the find bacteria that are useful for biomining?
a. cold spring c. pond
b. hot spring d. soil
Lesson 6 Biodiversity
Visit a pond, forest, or park near your home and do the activity found in the box
below.
25
You have just seen the different life forms in soil, water and mining sites that best
survive the variety of conditions found on Earth. They exemplify biodiversity. Biodiversity
is potentially renewable resource. There are three levels of biodiversity- genetic ( variety in
the genetic makeup among individuals in the species), species diversity ( variety among
the species or distinct types of organisms found in the different habitats of the planet), and
ecological ( variety of forests, deserts, grasslands, streams, lakes, oceans, wetlands, and
other biological communities).
Biodiversity is not evenly distributed throughout the biosphere. It is highest in the
tropics and declines toward each pole in land, freshwater and oceans. There are more
species in coral reefs in Indonesian archipelago and declines westward across the Pacific
Ocean. Some regions of the world contain unusually large concentrations of species and
are called biodiversity hotspots. The Island of Madagascar, the Cape region of South
Africa, the Great Barrier reef of Australia are biodiversity hotspots.
Biodiversity has direct and indirect value to man.
This rich variety of genes, species, and biological communities gives us food, wood,
fibers, energy, raw materials, industrial chemicals, and medicines. It also provides us with
free recycling, purification, and natural pest control services.
Despite the enormous number of life forms on earth, many organisms have
disappeared from the environment. Others are on the verge of being wiped out from the
earth. There are many causes that lead to the decrease or disappearance (extinction) of
biodiversity. Some of the causes are
26
The country has lots of endangered organisms. Examples are monkey-eating eagle
in Mindanao, tamaraw in Mindoro and the smallest fish at Lake Buhi, Bicol. However, hope
is not lost. We can do something to our biodiversity resource. We can reverse the trend
and save biodiversity by
Another activity of conservation biology is creation of national parks and wildlife. One
of the best national parks is Mt. Guiting-guitingin Sibuyan Island, Romblon.
Direction: Select the letter of the choice that correctly answers the question.
27
3. Biodiversity is uniformly distributed throughout the world.
a. true b. false
Let’s summarize
28
Posttest
Direction: Encircle the letter which answers the question
1. Which one does not belong to the group?
a. solar capital b. water resources c. biodiversity d. soil
2. Because fish and animals produce young, they are considered
a. limited
b. recyclable
c. exhaustible
d. renewable
3. A resource that is destroyed when used, but can be replaced is said to be
a. a mineral
b. recyclable
c. renewable
d. nonrenewable
4. The thin layer of soil on which crops grow is called
a. subsoil
b. topsoil
c. parent material
d. weathered bedrock
5. Plowing across the slopes of hills to prevent topsoil erosion in known as
a. fertilizing
b. strip mining
c. crop rotation
d. contour farming
6. Which of the following sources of water that can easily be contaminated?
a. groundwater
b. surface water
c. marine water
d. polar caps
7. Which of the following is NOT a biotic resource?
a. wood
b. cotton
c. leather
d. petroleum
8. All of these resources are nonrenewable EXCEPT
a. gold
b. water
c. iron ore
d. petroleum
9. Which of the following minerals is used as soil conditioner?
a. copper
b. lead oxide
c. calcium oxide
d. magnesium oxide
29
10. Which of the following is NOT a method of soil conservation?
a. building terraces to prevent erosion
b. using contour faming to retain topsoil
c. cutting forests to provide more cropland
d. rotating crops to keep nutrients in the soil
11. In which step of wastewater treatment that microorganisms are utilized?
a. primary water treatment
b. secondary water treatment
c. tertiary water treatment
d. all steps employ microorganisms
12. The process of enriching the soil by planting different varieties of plants is known as
a. fertilizing
b. terracing
c. crop rotation
d. contour plowing
13. When people practice conservation, they
a. increase deposits of mineral resources
b. stop their use of energy resources
c. worsen the problem of scarcity
d. use the resources wisely
14. Building flat, step-like fields with rock barriers to hold back soil on mountains is
a. alley farming
b. cause of runoff
c. crop rotation
d. terracing
15. The material in soil formed from decayed plant material is called
a. subsoil
b. humus
c. leachate
d. nutrients
16. The process of removing topsoil to reach minerals near the surface is known as
a. placer mining
b. cross mining
c. shaft mining
d. strip mining
17. Which of the following minerals cannot be recycled?
a. iron
b. coal
c. gold
d. aluminum
30
Key to Answers
1. A 7. D
2. A 8. D 1. D 4. B
3. D 9. B 2. D
4. B 10. B 3. D
5. D 11. D
6. C 12. C
13. D
Self-test 2.1 Self-test 3.1
1. D 3. D
2. D
1.C 4. C
2. B 5. C
Self-Test 4.1 Self-Test 5.1
3. D 6. A
1. D 4. D 1. D 4. B
2. B 5. D 2. B 5. B
3. D 3. C
Self-Test 6.1
1. D 4. C
2. D 5. D
3. B
Posttest
1. A 10. C
2. D 11. B
3. C 12. C
4. B 13. D
5. D 14. D
6. B 15. B
7. D 16. D
8. B 17. B
9. C
31
-End of Module-
References:
Miller, T. (2000). Environmental Science. New Jersey, USA: Prentice Hall, Inc.
http://www.groundwater.org/gi/contaminationconcerns.html
http://ohioline.osu.edu/aex-fact/0768.html
http://www.asla.org/awards/2004/04winners/entry557.html
32
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 12
1
Module 12
Inside the Solid Earth
You have observed changes on the surface of the Earth. Some changes occur slowly
while others occur fast. Why is the surface of the Earth never flat? What are the forces
responsible for these changes? This module provides you information and activities that will
help you understand the solid part of the Earth. The lessons contained in this module are:
2
How to learn from this module
I. Multiple Choice
Direction: Encircle the letter of the word or group of words that best answers the
question.
3
5. Which type of rock is abundant in volcanic regions?
a. igneous
b. sedimentary
c. metamorphic
d. both sedimentary and metamorphic
10. The magma in the magma chamber of a volcano has a very high amount of silica. If
the volcano would erupt, which of the following might happen?
a. there is a build up of pressure below the crater of the volcano
b. the volcano would erupt violently
c. the lava flow is very slow
d. all of the above
11. There are different kinds of seismic waves that occur during an earthquake. Which of
the following is most damaging to the structures on the surface of the Earth?
a. secondary waves
b. primary waves
c. body waves
d. all of the above
4
12. The occurrence of tsunami is one of the dangers of an earthquake. When is a
tsunami produced?
a. every time an earthquake occurs
b. when the epicenter of the earthquake is on land
c. when the epicenter of the earthquake is under water
d. every time an earthquake accompanies volcanic eruption
13. In which of the following soil does water run through readily?
a. clay
b .loam
c .sand
e. soil with many pebbles
14.Which of the found is agent of erosion
a. animals
b. plant
c. wind
d. weathering
a. __________________________ b. ________________________
__________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________
Before you start the lessons, familiarize yourself with the following terms :
Terms Definition
Crust - the outer portion of the earth
Continental Crust - the thick parts of the Earth's crust, not located
under the ocean
Oceanic Crust - the thin parts of the Earth's crust located under the
oceans.
5
Mantle
Lower Mantle - the deepest parts of the mantle, just above the core
(semi-rigid)
Upper Mantle (rigid) - the uppermost part of the mantle, part of the
Lithosphere
Upper Mantle (flowing) - the lower part of the upper mantle that exhibits
Asthenosphere plastic (flowing) properties. It is located below the
lithosphere (the crust and upper mantle)
Mohorovicic discontinuity - separates the crust and the upper mantle
Lithosphere - the crust plus the rigid, upper mantle
Plate - A section of the earth crust that floats on the
surface of the mantle
Glacier - a field of ice which moves slowly downward over
slope
Ridge - a raised mass of land with long width and height
Continent - big body of land on the globe
Drift - that which is carried onward by a current
Fossils - a remain or trace of organism in the past
Fissure - a narrow opening; a slitting or break
Erosion - a process by which sediments/soil are transported
to places of lower level
Agents - one which acts, any substance having the power
to change
Enrich - to fertilize, to adorn, to stock with
Bulk - large mass
Trough - a long, narrow container for water
Have you ever wondered what is under the ground? You leave your footprints in sand
and soil. You touch the soil and play with it. You get some soil samples and identify the
substances present in the soil. But nobody has seen beyond the area humans have
conducted mining activities.
However, man has invented instruments to get information from the depths of the
Earth. One such information is on vibration. These vibrations have been recorded and
analyzed. Do you know that the Earth’s interior is a layered structure composed of core,
mantle and crust? Table 1 summarizes the nature of the different layers inside Planet Earth.
6
Table 1.1 Layers of the Earth’s Interior and their Characteristics
Located between the crust and the mantle is the Mohorovicic discontinuity. It
separates the crust and the upper mantle. The outermost layer of the Earth is divided into
lithosphere and asthenosphere. Lithosphere is rigid, composed of the crust and upper part
of the mantle. Asthenosphere is part of the mantle that flows like plastic.
7
Lesson 2 Minerals and Rocks
The crust is the only layer we can access directly. Why? We plant food crops on it.
The elements listed in Table 1 do not exist as elements in the crust. Instead , each element
is tightly linked or tied to other elements to form naturally occurring chemical compounds
called minerals.
Minerals
are
are solid inorganic have definite
chemical
composition
are naturally
formed
have
characteristics
There are different kinds of minerals. They are classified according to their properties,
chemical composition or uses. Table 2.1 lists the common groups of minerals with
corresponding examples and uses.
8
. What you will do
Activity 2.1
Minerals are building blocks of rocks. What are rocks? Rocks are the most common
materials we can see in our surrounding.
Rocks are ….
composed of one
naturally or more minerals
occurring solids non-living
One rock type can change into another types of rocks. For instance, an igneous rock
can change into sedimentary and later into metamorphic rock. How do we call this chain of
changes? It is called a rock cycle. Fig. 2 shows the rock cycle.
9
Wind and water can break rocks into pieces. They can also carry rock pieces to
another place. Usually, the rock pieces, called sediments, drop from the wind or water to
make a layer. The layer can be buried under other layers of sediments. After a long time the
sediments become a sedimentary rock.
As you can see in the discussion of rock cycle, there are three kinds of rocks. Each
has a different texture and origin. Let’s find out more about these rocks.
Igneous rocks
Sedimentary Rocks
Sedimentary rocks develop from sediments. Sediments are tiny grains of dirt,
sand, mud and clay weathered or worn off rocks. These are then washed into
streams, rivers, lakes and oceans and they settle in the bottom of these bodies of
water. Minerals in the water and very tiny sea animals become mixed with the dirt
and sand to form layers of sediment. Every day more sediments are added. After
thousands and millions of years deep accumulations of sediment are produced. The
weight and pressure from the upper layers turn the sediment in the bottom into
sedimentary rocks.
Examples of sedimenetary rocks are limestone, conglomerate, shale and
sandstone. The Island of Cebu is famous for its limestone and dolomite deposits.
10
Metamorphic rocks
These rocks can come from igneous rocks, sedimentary rocks or even from
other metamorphic rocks. How are these rocks formed? When a rock is subjected to
high temperature, high pressure and chemically active fluids, it becomes unstable and
begins to re-crystallize into different stable minerals. This causes change in the
composition of the rock as well as the rock type. Some examples of metamorphic
rocks are listed in Table 2. The Island of Romblon
is famous for its marble
Table 2 Examples of metamorphic rock rocks. Mindoro Island
has marble rocks ,too.
Metamorphic rock Origin
marble limestone
slate shale
quartzite Quartz sandstone
Schist slate
1. Visit a area in your place where you can find rocks such as river, park,
construction store, etc. Note the rocks that interest you.
2. Request your father or relatives to accompany you to the place where you
found the rocks.
3. Ask your companion the local name of the rocks and how people used the
rocks. You may also ask the reason/s for its use
11
. What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
1. There are many elements present in the crust. Which is the most dominant element
found in the crust?
a. carbon c. oxygen
b. nitrogen d. phosphorus
2. The lithosphere is composed of the
3. Which of the following rocks are formed from sediments accumulated at the bottom of
the oceans thousands of years ago?
a. extrusive igneous rocks
b. intrusive igneous rocks
c. metamorphic rocks
d. sedimentary rocks
II. Match the rocks in column A with its mineral or uses in Column B
A B
1. limestone a. jewelry
2. marble b. CaCO3
3. gypsum c. plaster of Paris
4. gold
12
Lesson 3 Different Landforms
What you need: old newspapers, modeling clay, and scotch tape
What to do:
1. Place two or more sheets of old newspaper one on top of the other.
2. Put your finge tips at each end of the pile of newspapers. Push the
newspaper towards each other. Observe and record what you see.
3. Pull the sheets of newspaper away from each other. Observe and record
what you observe.
4. Make another pile of newspapers. Place the second pile beside the first
pile. Secure the piles with adhesive tape so the newspaper sheets in each
pile will not separate from each other. Slide the piles side to side.
5. What does the newspaper represent?
6. What is represented by the push, pull and slide?
13
In Activity 3.1, the newspaper pile represents the crustal rocks. The pile of
newspapers ( rocks) were subjected to stress such as push (compression) , pull (tension)
and slide (shearing). Compression, tension and shearing change the rocks’ volume, shape
or both. It causes rocks to fold or crack. As rocks are compressed, they produce wrinkles.
The upward fold in the rock is the anticline which forms hills and mountains. The downward
fold is the syncline which forms valleys.
As you pull rocks apart, the middle of the rock becomes thinner. When rocks slide past
each other, a break or fault is formed. If there are many faults in an area, what are formed?
You have a series of uplifted areas (mountains) and valleys between mountains.
Other land forms are plateaus and domes. What are they and how are they formed?
Plateaus are raised rock layers that remain flat. If a river separate one large plateau into
smaller ones, you have canyons. The most beautiful canyon is the Grand Canyon in the
Colorado Plateau. Baguio City is a plateau.
How about a dome? A dome is an uplifted area created by rising magma. It is shaped
like the top half of a sphere.
You can see other landforms due to forces operating below the surface of the earth
as shown in Table 3.1
14
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
Name places in the Philippines where there are beautiful mountains, valleys, plateaus
and domes.
Get a map or a globe and try to locate the seven continents – Africa, Antarctica, Asia,
Australia, Europe, North America and South America, The seven continents are separated
by the seven famous world’s oceans. You may be wondering where and how the continents
were formed. Let us do activity 4.1.
Question:
Which continents do you think were neighbors before?
15
You could have
produced a figure similar
to Fig. 4.1. This was what
Alfred Wegener figured
out in 1912.
The two continents further broke up. In 1915, he proposed the Theory of Continental
Drift which states that parts of the Earth’s crust slowly move away from each other on top of
a liquid core. What are the evidences? The evidences that supported the continental drift
theory are the following:
16
Wegener’s idea left queries in the science community unanswered. An example of
these questions is, “How can continents plow through hard, solid ocean floor”? These
questions pushed scientists to make more studies which led to the discovery of mid-oceanic
ridge. A mid- oceanic ridge is an underwater mountain. One of this is the famous Mid-
Atlantic Ridge, a vast undersea mountain chain in the Atlantic Ocean. It has a gigantic cleft
about 32-48 km long and 1.6 km deep. The ridge is offset by fracture zones or rift valleys.
In this cleft, the liquid rock called basaltic magma from the mantle rises up to the
floor of the ocean. The hot magma cools down and hardens to form new oceanic crust. The
new crust pushed the older rocks away from the ridge. This is called seafloor-spreading
theory by Harry Hess (1962) and R. Deitz (1961). What findings support the seafloor
spreading theory?
How did they explain the observations listed above? New crusts were added at the
ridges of the ocean floor, pushing the old rocks away from the ridges. Also, old crusts were
reabsorbed in the ocean trench. A trench is the deepest part of the ocean floor.
Just like continental drift theory, the seafloor spreading theory left some gaps. From
these two theories, a new theory evolved. This is called Plate Tectonic Theory. This theory
states that the lithosphere is broken into a number of rigid moving slabs called plates. The
plates are either oceanic plates ( under the ocean) and continental plates ( in the continents)
as shown in Fig. 4.3.
17
The plates move relative to each other above a hotter, deeper, more mobile zone, the
asthenosphere. The asthenosphere is kept plastic-like by heat produced from unstable light
elements. How do we explain the movement of the lithospheric plates? The very hot
substance in the asthenosphere is light and it rises towards the crust where it cools. Cold
material is denser and sinks downward. The repeated rising and sinking of materials creates
convection currents similar to the event shown in Fig. 4.4.
18
There are three types of plate movements – separation of two plates (divergent) ,
collision of two plates ( convergent) and sliding past each other ( transform). What is formed
at plate boundaries as the plates move relative to each other ? Study at Fig. 4.5.
Fig. 4.5 can help you understand plate tectonics. At Point A, continental plate
collides with another continental plate. A fold is formed as what you observed when you
pushed two sheets of newspapers. The fold is the mountain. Mt. Everest and the Himalayan
mountain range were formed in this manner as the Indian plate collided with the southern
part of Asia. We call this the convergent plate boundary movement.
At Point B, two plates move away from each other. This is a divergent plate
boundary. This results to the formation of new crust to widen the sea floor, new ocean basin
or a rift valley such as the great African Rift Valley.
At Point C, an oceanic plate collides with a continental plate. The heavier oceanic
plate sinks while the lighter continental plate moves up. These movements form a trench
and a volcanic arc. This is a convergent plate boundary.
Not shown in Fig. 4.5 are the collision of an oceanic plate with another oceanic plate
as well as the side-to-side movement of plates (lateral slipping or transform). The collision of
two oceanic plates forms a trench and an island arc. This is how the Philippines and Japan
were formed.
When two plates move sideways against each other, great friction is developed. The
movement is jerky. The plates slip, then stick together as friction and pressure increase .
This pressure is suddenly released resulting to an earthquake.
Column A Column B
19
2. Match A with B
A B
1. large underwater mountain chain around the earth a. convergent
2. plate boundary movement that forms new crust b. divergent
3. plate boundary movement that destroys crust c. lateral slipping
4. plate boundary movement that produces friction d. mid-ocean ridge
4. What is formed when plates are pulled away from each other?
a. Island arc
b. Rift valley
c. Volcanic arc
d. Mountain range
5. Explain why the Philippines has many volcanoes, experiences lots of earthquakes, and
is composed of many islands.
Have you heard of igneous activity? Igneous activity is the process of bringing
material from the deep interior of a planet and spilling it on the surface. This may lead to the
formation of new crust. How is the new crust formed? It starts from the hot material from
below. This hot material called magma comes from two sources. It may be produced when
given two lithospheric plates, one slab of crust is forced back down into the deeper regions
of the Earth as shown in Figure 5.1. This process is called subduction. The slab that is
forced back into the Earth usually undergoes melting when the edges get to a depth which
is hot enough.
20
The magma may also come from the
deeper part of the interior of the earth. The
hot magma rises and gathers at a
reservoir found in a weak portion of the
overlying rock called the magma chamber.
The magma comes to the surface to form
a volcano or island.
A volcano is a place on the Earth's
surface where molten rock, gases and
pyroclastic debris erupt through the earth's
crust.
Crater
slope
base
What are the parts of a volcano? A
volcano has a summit, slope and base. At
the summit, you have an opening called
vent. A vent may be a crater or caldera. A
crater is a funnel-shaped depression at the
top of a volcano formed as a result of
explosive eruptions. A volcano may have
one crater like the Mayon Volcano or more
than one crater like the Taal Volcano, which
has 47 craters.
Volcanoes erupt in two ways. Some volcanoes erupt through a circular vent above
a tube-shaped chimney. Other volcanoes erupt out of a long crack, called fissure, and
produce a curtain of lava as shown in Fig. 5.3
21
Fig. 5.3 Circular vent & crack-like
What determines the nature of eruption? It depends on the viscosity of the magma.
Viscosity is a measure of a material’s resistance to flow . Higher viscosity materials flow with
great difficulty . Viscosity is controlled by
The higher the temperature , the less viscous the magma is. An important substance
in the magma is silica (SiO2). The higher the silica present in the magma, the higher its
viscosity. Dissolved gases also affect the mobility of the magma. Gases expand within a
magma as they get near the Earth’s surface due to decreasing pressure. The violence of an
eruption is related to how easily gases escape from magma. Fluid basaltic lavas generally
produce quiet eruptions. Highly viscous lavas (rhyolite or andesite) produce more explosive
eruptions. The magma of Philippine volcanoes has high silica content. Thus, our volcanoes
erupt violently.
Many Filipinos have witnessed the damage done to Central Luzon when Mt.
Pinatubo erupted in 1992. What did the volcano release? One material released was the
22
lava. Lava may be thrown into air or may flow out of the opening of the volcano. Lava flows
depend on the viscosity of the magma. The collage below shows the different lava flows.
–Built from ejected lava –has broad, slightly –Most are located adjacent
(mainly cinder-sized) domed-shaped to the Pacific Ocean
fragments –is composed - Large, classic-shaped
–has steep slope angle primarily of basaltic volcano (thousands of
–is rather small in size lava ft. high & several
–Frequently occurs in –generally covers miles wide at base)
groups large areas –Composed of interbedded
- Famous example is –is produced by mild lava flows and layers of
Paricutin in Mexico and eruptions of large pyroclastic debris
Sunset Crater in volumes of lava - Examples are Mt.
Arizona –examples are Fujiyama, Mt. St. Helens, Mt.
Mauna Loa and Pinatubo, Mt. Mayon.
Kilauea in Hawaii
Cracks form in the rocks surrounding the magma chambers. Magma from the magma
chamber creeps up very slowly into these cracks. These areas are colder than the magma
chamber. What will happen to the invading magma? The magma cools down slowly without
reaching the surface. The result of this slow process is igneous rock structures called
plutons. Plutons are classified according to shape -–tabular (sheetlike)”and or “ massive.
What are the different types of plutons or intrusive igneous features?
24
. What you will do
Self-Test 5.1
Our country has 220 volcanoes and 21 volcanoes are active. Examples are Taal
Volcano and Mayon Volcano. There are dangers during volcanic eruptions. Volcanic
eruption may occur when there is intense storm. We learned earlier that volcanic ash fall
and release of other pyroclastics are dangers of volcanic eruptions. Landslides may also
occur. The boxes below may help you what to do in midst of these dangers.
1. Be familiar with the land around you to better assess your risk of danger.
2. Watch the patterns of storm-water drainage on slopes near your home.
3. Watch the hillsides around your home for any signs of land movement, such
as small landslides or debris flows, or progressively tilting trees.
25
What to do in case of an ashfall
General Principles
• In ashy areas, use dust masks and eye protection. If you don't have a dust
mask, use a wet handkerchief.
• Keep ash out of buildings, machinery, air and water supplies, downspouts,
stormdrains, etc.
• Stay indoors to minimize exposure -- especially if you have respiratory ailments.
• Minimize travel
• Don't tie up phone line with non-emergency calls.
• Use your radio for information on the ashfall.
• Keep the following at home:
• Close doors, windows and dampers. Place damp towels at door thresholds and
other draft sources; tape drafty windows.
• Dampen ash in yard and streets to reduce resuspension.
• Put stoppers in the tops of your drainpipes (at the gutters).
• Protect dust sensitive electronics.
• Since most roofs cannot support more than four inches of wet ash, keep roofs
free of thick accumulation. Once ashfall stops, sweep or shovel ash from roofs
and gutters. Wear your dust mask and use precaution on ladders and roofs.
• Remove outdoor clothing before entering a building. Brush, shake and pre-soak
ashy clothing before washing.
26
What to do before landslides
1. Stay away from the slide area. There may be danger of additional slides.
2. Check for injured and trapped persons near the slide, without entering the
direct slide area. Direct rescuers to their locations.
3. Help neighbors who may require special assistance--infants, seniors and
people with disabilities.
4. Listen to local radio or television stations for the latest emergency information.
5. Watch for flooding, which may occur after a landslide or debris flow. Floods
sometimes follow landslides because they may be started by the same event.
6. Look for and report broken utility lines to appropriate authorities. Reporting
potential hazards will get the utilities turned off as quickly as possible,
preventing further hazard and injury.
7. Check the building foundation, chimney and surrounding land for damage.
Such damage may help you assess the safety of the area.
8. Replant damaged ground as soon as possible since erosion caused by loss of
ground cover can lead to flash flooding.
9. Seek the advice of a geotechnical expert for evaluating landslide hazards or
designing corrective techniques to reduce landslide risk.
27
Lesson 6 Earthquake
Look at Fig. 6.1. Determine the extent of damage done to this place. What caused
this damage? Probably, this is due to an earthquake.
Have you experienced earthquake? If not, ask your elders to describe the shaking of
the earth during an earthquake. Do Activity 6.1.
What to do:
1. Interview a friend, an elder or school officials who have
unforgettable experience of an earthquake. You may interview
several individuals.
2. Get the following information:
a. Date of Earthquake (Month and
Year)_________________________
b. Time it occurred ___________________
c. Where were you? _____________________
d. If you were inside, describe building and specific room. If
outside, describe location (e.g.; sidewalk in front of
department store).
e. What were you doing when the earthquake occurred?
f. f. What happened? What did you see, hear, feel? What did
you and those around you do?
g. How did you feel?
28
The people you have interviewed may gave you the following: - ground rumbles,
hanging lamps swing back and forth, bookshelves rattles, water spills from a shaking glass,
floor and walls sway, and so on.
Plate Tectonic Theory can be used to explain the occurrence of an earthquake. The
crust has lots of large and small cracks called faults. But you can not see the faults even if
they are very long. The cracks are buried deep underground and the pieces of crust are
compressed together very tightly. The powerful forces that compress these crustal pieces
also cause them to move very slowly. When two pieces that are next to each other get
pushed in different directions, they will stick together for many years. However, these forces
pushing on them will break apart cracks and separated cracks move. This sudden shift in
the rock shakes all of the rock around it. These vibrations, called seismic waves, travel
outward in all directions. We call the shaking of the earth as an earthquake. The
underground location where the rock first broke apart or shifted is called the focus of the
earthquake. The area above the focus is called epicenter.
What are the different ways the crust at the cracks shake? The pieces may move
side by side as shown in the figure below or up and down. The movement creates different
kinds of waves.
29
1. Primary or P waves cause rocks to 2. Secondary or S waves cause
push or pull forward. It is the fastest rock to move side to side like a
wave and travels down into the earth snake. It is the second fastest wave
and travels deep into the earth.
The shaking would last for a few seconds to a couple of minutes. After shock may
follow. There are thousands of earthquakes annually but many are not felt. What are the
dangers of an earthquake?
landslide
Fire due to
damage on gas
and electrical
wiring
Soil turns fluid
(Liquifaction) which
happened in La ground
Union and Dagupan subsidence
during the
Cabanatuan and
Baguio Eathquakes
Extent of damage depends on
intensity and duration of
vibrations, nature of materials
Tsunami, a giant where structures are located
wave, is produced and design of the structure
when the epicenter 30
is under water.
Earthquake may also be caused by volcanic eruptions. People in the vicinity of Mt
Pinatubo felt many quakes prior to the actual eruption.
III Very feeble shock Felt by several persons at rest; strong enough
for the direction or duration to be appreciable.
IV Feeble shock Felt by persons in motion, disturbance of
movable objects, doors, windows, cracking of
ceilings
V Shock of moderate Felt generally by everyone; disturbance of
intensity furniture, beds, etc., ringing of some bells
VI Fairly strong shock General awakening of those asleep; general
ringing of bells; oscillation of chandeliers;
stopping of clocks; visible agitation of trees and
shrubs; some startled persons leaving their
dwellings.
VII Strong shock Overthrow of movable objects, fall of plaster;
ringing of church bells. general panic , without
damage to buildings.
VIII. Very strong shock Fall of chimneys; cracks in the walls of buildings.
IX. Extremely strong Partial or total destruction of some buildings,
shock
X. Shock of extreme . Great disaster; ruins; disturbance of the strata,
intensity fissures in the ground, rock falls from mountains.
From: Earthquakes and Volcanic Eruptions. A Handbook on Risk Assessment
by Herbert Tiedemann. Swiss Reinsurance Company, Zurich, 1992.
31
Globally, scientists measure magnitude. Magnitude is a measure of the amount of
energy released during an earthquake expressed in Richter scale or other magnitude
scales. The magnitude is calculated by measuring the amplitude of waves recorded on a
seismogram, correcting for the distance between the recording instrument and the
earthquake epicenter. The magnitude scale is logarithmic. Thus, an earthquake of
magnitude 6 produces vibrations with amplitudes 10 times greater than those from a
magnitude 5 earthquake and 100 times greater than those from a magnitude 4 earthquake.
Before an Earthquake
1. Secure anything that can be toppled by an earthquake
2. Know how to turn off electricity in your house.
3. Note the nearest accessible exit whenever you enter a building for the first
time.
4. Hold fire and earthquake drill at home, in school and offices so everyone will
know what to do and where to go.
During an Earthquake
1. Keep calm, do not panic.
2. If you are outdoors, move out into an open area away from buildings, which
might collapse, and from electric power lines which can snap and electrocute.
3. If caught indoors or in a high-rise building, take cover under tables, desk or
bed. You can stay under door frames. Do not use elevator.
4. In school or office, do what you practiced during the earthquake and fire drills.
5. Turn off electricity.
32
After an Earthquake
1. Check electrical devices for any damage before using them again.
2. Inspect house for cracks in its support.
3. Do not go inside collapse structures to get belongings. After shocks may occur
anytime.
4. Do not go sightseeing. It is dangerous and you may hamper rescue operations
and relief works.
. 5. Tune in to emergency channels or radio stations for latest information from
local authorities on what to do and where to get medical assistance, food and
water supplies, temporary shelter and other vital information. .
1. Look at the picture below. Make an essay about the picture to explain your concern
as criterion to avoid such thing to happen.
33
Lesson 7. Soil Formations
Have you ever asked anyone where soil came from? There are five important factors
that lead to soil formation.
1. It all started with a parent material such as bedrock, organic material, an old soil
surface, a deposit from water, wind, glaciers, volcanoes or material moving down the
side of a mountain being exposed to agents.
2. The agent such as heat, rain, ice, snow, wind, sunshine and other environmental
factors break down the parent material
3. Plant roots and animals help break the rock into pieces. Microorganisms also release
substances such as acid which can make rock brittle.
4. Then Dead plants and animals become organic matter that makes the soil rich.
5. Topography influences how climate affect soil formation. More water is present at the
bottom of the hill than at the slope. The side of the landscape facing the sun is drier
than away from the sun
34
A Horizon
.
B Horizon
C Horizon
What to do
1. Fill both troughs with garden soil. Plant one trough with grass
2. Place a wood under one end of the troughs to tilt it slightly.
3. Place a basin in front of the untilted end of the troughs.
4. Pour the same amount of water at one end of the trough and observe the flow
of water.
5. Collect the water that flows into the basin.
6. Compare the presence of soil particles in the collected water in both troughs.
7. How do plants prevent erosion?
8. How do we prevent soil erosion?
35
From the activity, you found out that soil could be transported from one place to
another. This process is called erosion. There are different agents of erosion. In the activity
that we have done, the agent of erosion is water. Other agents are wind, gravity and even
man. The transported materials are deposited in low-lying areas, rivers, lakes and oceans.
Once they reach the ocean, they are re-deposited as marine sediments.
Because of more soil formation and erosion, soil profiles change as you move across
a landscape and as you move downward deeper into the soil at one location.
Let’s summarize
1. There are three layers of the Earth’s interior – core, mantle and crust. Each has
unique characteristics
2. Crust is the only layer directly accessible to humans. It contains different kinds of
minerals. Minerals aggregate to form rocks
3. There three kinds of rocks-igneous rocks, sedimentary rocks, and metamorphic
rocks.
4. Different kinds of rocks are formed in different ways. Igneous rocks are formed
through slow or fast cooling of magma that escape the magma chamber.
Metamorphic rock is under intense pressure and temperature. Sedimentary rock is
formed through deposition, compaction and cementation of sediments.
5. The surface of the earth is always changing. Thus, there are many landforms such as
mountains, valleys, volcanoes, plateaus, domes, etc.
6. There are two opposing forces that shape the surface of the earth – subsurface
activity and surface activity. An example of subsurface activity is igneous activity.
Weathering is a surface activity.
7. Continental drift theory, sea-floor spreading theory and plate tectonic theory are used
to explain the changes on the surface of the earth due to subsurface activities that
produce mountains , volcanoes and islands
36
8. Surface activity like weathering causes wear and tear of the crust leading to formation
of soil.
9. Sediments are products of weathering and are transported and deposited in other
areas.
10. Water and wind are agents of erosion
11. There are five factors that form soil.
Posttest
Direction: Encircle the letter of the word or group of words that best answers the
questions.
37
7. Which of the following stresses results to cracks in the crust?
8. Folds are formed when the earth’s crust bends. Which of the following is formed
during formation of folds?
a. the syncline becomes a plateau while anticline forms the plain
b. the syncline becomes the lain while the anticline forms the ocean bed.
c. the syncline becomes the mountains while the anticline forms the valley.
d. the syncline form into valley while the anticline becomes the mountains
10. A landform that is not faulted or folded but raised and its top is flat is called
11 . If the temperature of the magma of a volcano is high and it contains low silica. The
lava flows ________ and the volcano would erupt _________.
13. Tsunami is one of the many dangers of earthquake. When does it occur?
14. In which part of the soil where microorganisms are most active?
a. A Horizon
b. B Horizon
c. C Horizon
d. Bed rock
38
15. A soil has specific profile. Which layer would have the most biological activities?
39
Key to answers
Pretest Self Test 2.1
Test I
1. A 6. D 11. C 1. C
2. D 7. D 12. C 2. C
3. C 8. A 13. C 3. D
4. D 9. C 14. C Test II
5. A 10. B 1. B 3. C
2. B 4. A
Self-Test 3.1
Mt. Apo in Davao City Mt. Makiling in Laguna
BanawI in Mountain Province Baguio City
Marikina Valley Sto. Tomas Mountain in Cordillera
Sierra Madre Mt. Maculot in Batangas
Bukidnon - Plateau Montalban, Rizal
40
Self-Test 6.1 Self-Test 7.1
1.
2. a. plate tectonics 1. exposed parent rocks,
b. most earthquakes agents of soil
happen along the formation , plants and
boundaries of tectonic animals, topography,
plates time
c. structural engineers 2. wind, water, rain, sun
should implement strict 3. top soil, subsoil,
building codes when parent rock
constructing houses, 4. plant trees, terracing
buildings and bridges
Post Test
1. B 6. B 11. D
2. B 7. C 12. A
3. C 8. D 13. A
4. A 9. D 14. A
5. C 10. B 15. C
References
Coble, C.R., et. Al. (1991). Earth Science. New Jersey, U.S.A.: Prentice Hall
Tarbuck, E.J. and F.K. Lutgens. (1995). Earth Science. Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey, U.S.A.: Prentice
Hall
41
Multi-HazardLast Updated: Monday, 01-Nov-2004 12:12:04 EST
42
43
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 13
1
Module 13
All About Water
Water is all around us. If you look at any globe or map of the world, you can see that
it is mostly blue. These blue areas represent the oceans, seas, and lakes on earth.
Water is a very important resource on earth. Almost every activity on earth needs
water. Can you imagine what your life would be like without water?
In this module you will learn more about water. The module consists of these lessons:
2
How to learn from this module
In order to achieve successfully the objectives of this module you have to be guided by
the following:
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer and write this on your answer sheet.
1. Which of the following contains the greatest amount of water by volume on earth?
a) oceans
b) glaciers and ice sheets
c) groundwater
d) atmosphere
2. What term best describes the never-ending transfer of water between the atmosphere
and the surface of the earth?
a) oxygen cycle c) hydrologic cycle
b) nitrogen cycle d) phosphorus cycle
3. It is the condensed water vapor that falls back to the surface of the earth.
a) cloud c) precipitation
b) table water d) groundwater
4. Of the following processes, which is responsible for getting water into the atmosphere?
a) evaporation c) condensation
b) sublimation d) precipitation
5. When spaces between rock particles fill with groundwater, the rock is
a. eroded
b. weathered
c. evaporated
d. saturated
3
6.The following affect the porosity of the soil or rock EXCEPT
a) shape of the particles
b) sorting of particles
c) packing of particles
d) slope
7. One of these is the correct sequence of the underground zones. Which is this?
a) water table, zone of aeration, zone of saturation
b) zone of aeration, zone of saturation, water table
c) zone of aeration, water table, zone of saturation
d) zone of saturation, water table, zone of aeration
10. Groundwater has many uses. It can be used as drinking water or as a source
of water for the producers. On which region is groundwater mostly stored?
a) zone of saturation
b) zone of aeration
c) discharge zone
d) recharge zone
4
Familiarity with the following terms will help you get the most from this module:
Terms Definition
1. Hydrosphere - The dynamic mass of liquid that is continually on the
move
6. Permeability -The measure of how fast water passes through the open
spaces in rocks and sediments
9. Zone of saturation -Rock layer where all the pore spaces are filled with water
12. Zone of aeration - Area above the zone of saturation where the pore spaces
are not yet fully filled with water
10. Wells - Openings that may be bored into the zone of saturation
where groundwater naturally flows
5
Lesson 1 Distribution of the World’s Water
Ocean 97.2
6
What you will do
Activity 1.1
The earth’s waters may be found in the atmosphere, on the surface, and
underground. The total amount of water on earth is estimated to be 1.36 billion
cubic kilometers. Of this total, 97.2% or 1.28 billion cubic kilometers is part of the
world’s oceans, 2.15% or .03 billion cubic kilometers exists as ice sheets and
glaciers, and 0.65% or .009 billion cubic kilometers is divided among lakes,
streams, subsurface water, and the atmosphere. Compared to the volume of
water in the ocean, the volume of subsurface water or groundwater, which is the
source of fresh water, is very small. A greater part of this freshwater is in the form
of ice and is not available for consumption. With the growing population, demand
for freshwater is increasing. There is really a need to conserve fresh water.
If you look at the globe or world map, you will find that the land and water
are not evenly distributed between the two hemispheres. There are more land
areas than water areas in the Northern Hemisphere while in the Southern
Hemisphere there are more water areas than land areas. For this reason, the
Northern Hemisphere is called the land hemisphere while the Southern
Hemisphere is called the water hemisphere.
7
What you will do
Activity 1.2 The Water Cycle
Materials Needed:
Procedure:
Did you notice that when the crushed ice was placed on the cover of a
wide-mouthed bottle with hot water, smoke-like material was observed inside the
bottle and after sometime moisture was formed in the sides of the bottle and the
inside part of the cover? Did you also notice that water droplets fall back to the
water from the top cover?
8
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
To find out if you learned from the previous discussion answer the
following questions
What is fresh water? Where does fresh water come from? This lesson will
help you learn more about the earth’s fresh water and ways on how to use it best.
Groundwater
In the water cycle, condensed water vapor falls back to the surface of the
earth as precipitation in different forms. Precipitation reaching the land areas may
either flow as runoff and become part of the streams and rivers eventually
reaching the oceans or may seep right into the soil. The seepage of precipitation
into the earth is called infiltration. Infiltration of water is possible because there
are spaces between soil or rock particles. Pores are usually filled with air that is
forced out as water enters these pores. The water that fills the pores between
rock particles is called infiltrates. Locations where surface water infiltrates the
groundwater system are known as recharge zones, while places where
groundwater flows or seeps out at the surface are discharge zones.
9
Figure 2.3: A cross-section of groundwater zones
Groundwater usually refers to the water that infiltrates. This is the water
underground. Groundwater is a bountiful source of freshwater on earth. About
90% of the earth’s freshwater is stored as groundwater.
Groundwater Movement
10
seepage. Generally, porous rocks allow more water to stay between particles in
rocks.
Figure 2.1. How Sorting, Shape, and Packing of Particles Affect Porosity
Materials needed:
11
Procedure:
1. Make 7-10 holes at the bottom of each plastic cup using the pencil nail.
2. Cover the holes with cheesecloth and tie the cloth with a rubber band.
3. Measure 3-cm from top of each cup. Mark it with a pencil line.
4. Fill cup #1 with sand up to the pencil line. To cups #2 and #3, do the
same but place clay and gravel instead.
5. Position the halved plastic container as shown. They will be used to
support the plastic cup and contents.
6. Pour 100-mL water into the plastic cup.
7. Record the time it takes for water to drip through the holes of the cup.
8. Transfer the water collected in the receiving container to the graduated
cylinder. Get its volume in mL.
9. Repeat steps # 6, 7 and 8 to cups 2 and 3.
10. Calculate the rate of drainage of each cup using this equation:
10. Calculate the amount of water (in %) retained in the soils in cups 1, 2 and
3.
Questions:
12
between particles are small. Permeability also depends on how interconnected
the pores are. If pores are interconnected, water can pass through easily.
Gravity and the permeability of rocks in the zone of saturation pull water
downward. How fast groundwater flows is affected by the permeability of
aquifers and the hydraulic gradient (steepness) of its water table.
The velocity of groundwater increases with increasing permeability of
rocks and steepness of slope of water table.
13
As rainwater seeps into the ground, some water clings to soil and roots of
plants near the surface. Some of this water provides plants with water they need.
The remaining water continues to seep into the ground if the rock is porous and
permeable. Aquifers are rocks that allow water to flow and wherein water can be
stored because they are highly porous and highly permeable. Water that
infiltrates may force out all the air in a rock and fills all the pores. This zone is
called the zone of saturation. But for aquifers to be saturated with groundwater,
the rock below it should be impermeable that will prevent the down flow of water
from an aquifer. This rock is an aquiclude. The upper boundary of the zone of
saturation is called the water table. Above the water table, the pore spaces in
rocks are not yet completely filled with water. Some pore spaces are still filled
with air. This zone is called the zone of aeration.
Go over the previous discussions about groundwater and answer the following
questions:
1. What is groundwater?
2. What is the source of groundwater?
3. Enumerate the factors that affect the movement of groundwater?
4. Explain how each factor enumerated in question 3 affects the movement
of groundwater?
Springs
Recall that in the hydrologic cycle, condensed water vapor that falls to the
ground seeps to the subsurface of the earth forming the groundwater. Where
does groundwater go?
14
Some springs contain so much dissolved minerals that they cannot be
used for ordinary drinking or washing purposes. These are called mineral springs.
Where do you think these minerals come from?
The high mineral content may come from very soluble rocks like salt
beds. In some, many minerals are dissolved from rocks because the spring water
contains large quantities of gases that form acids when mixed with water such as
carbon dioxide or hydrogen sulfide. Or, if the spring water is very hot, it is likely to
have a high mineral content since minerals dissolve better in hot water.
Wells
People have also devised ways to access groundwater. Openings may be
bored into the zone of saturation forming wells. A well may dry up during dry
season when the water table falls below the normal level.
Running Water
You might have read from world history books that the first civilizations
emerged along fertile river valleys. The rivers’ fertile floodplains have fostered
human progress since the dawn of civilization. The Nile River, for example has
been harnessed not only to supply hydroelectricity, but for constant irrigation. It is
navigable the year round from its mouth to as far as Uganda. You are familiar
with the Pasig River. Think of the many uses of that river.
Rivers are bodies of inland water that flow in natural channels. Aside from
being an important component of the hydrologic cycle, rivers and other running
water have many uses. Silt deposited by the river’s annual overflow has brought
15
agricultural prosperity throughout the world. We depend upon rivers for irrigation,
transportation, energy, and for food. Do you know where rivers and other running
water come from?
Spring water and water from wells flow on the earth’s surface. This runoff
initially flows over wide areas and enter small streams. As streams flow down
mountain slopes they join with other streams. A stream that joins other streams is
called a tributary. Water in small streams enters larger streams or rivers.
Streams vary in size and shape. Larger streams formed by the meeting of small
streams are sometimes called rivers, the two terms, are however,
interchangeable. Water in streams eventually makes its way to the sea.
A river’s drainage pattern and channel shape both change over time as
does the landscape through which the river flows. A channel is the path of any
stream.
Young stream flow rapidly down the steep slopes of mountains or hills.
They are characterized by steep slopes and rapid flow. A relatively small volume
of water flows in young streams. As a stream flows downhill, particles of soil are
carried along the ground. Because of the rapid flow, erosion happens fast
resulting to narrow V – shaped valley. Waterfalls and rapids are associated with
youthful rivers.
Once a stream has cut its channel closer to base level, downward erosion
becomes less dominant. Mature streams curve down graded slopes, eroding
their sides on the way. The result is the widening of the valley producing
floodplain. The stream flowing in the flood plain bends. This is called a meander.
As the stream moves to the sides, the outer bank is eroded causing the meander
to continually change position. Deposition of sediments like sand takes place
since the stream current at the inside of the meander is slow.
Streams enter old age after it has cut its floodplain several times wider
than the width of the meander. The stream at this stage is far from the valley wall.
As the floodplain is no longer increasing, shifting of streams occur more rapidly.
Old rivers are very muddy, a consequence of large amount of sediments carried
by a river with low velocity.
16
Lakes
These bodies of water have many uses to humans. Aside from providing
people with a source of livelihood, lakes can generate electricity and can serve
as a means of transportation. Lakes also add beauty and scenery to the place.
Some famous lakes in the country are Taal Lake, Lake Lanao, and Laguna de
Bay. What other lakes do you know?
By volcanic action. During volcanic eruptions, a lava flow can build a dam
across a valley. When a volcano runs out of magma, it collapses and leaves a
depression that eventually becomes filled with water.
By river action. Fallen trees and other debris clog rivers creating a dam
that will cause a river to back up thus forming a lake.
1. lakes ________________
2. springs ________________
3. wells ________________
4. rivers ________________
5. oceans ________________
6. streams ________________
7. coastal waters ________________
17
Lesson 3 Ocean Waters
Do you know why the earth is called a blue planet? Look at the globe or
world map. Do you notice that the earth consists mostly of water? The oceans
cover 70% of the earth’s surface, so it is called a blue planet. In this lesson, you
will be able to:
1. In a globe or the map, identify the (a) biggest ocean in the world and (b)
the smallest ocean.
Composition of Seawater
When you swim in the sea, you sometimes accidentally drink water. What
does it taste like? This section will help you learn about the composition of the
ocean water.
18
What you will do
Activity 3.2 What is in ocean water?
1. If your place is near the sea, get a spoonful of seawater. If far from the sea,
get a spoonful of salt and dissolve in ¼ cup of water. This will represent your
seawater. Get a spoonful from this solution.
2. Place the seawater or the salt solution in a beaker or any heat resistant
container.
3. Heat the seawater or the salt solution until the water boils. Lower the flame.
Continue heating until all the water has evaporated. Immediately remove the
container from the flame once all the water has evaporated.
4. Observe what is left at the bottom and sides of the container.
Did you notice that whitish grains are left at the bottom and sides of the
container? These grains are salt crystals. These make the seawater salty. These
are the same particles you observe on your skin when you get out of the sea and
water in your skin has dried up. The percentage of salt in a given volume of
seawater is called salinity.
1. Look at Figure 3.1 to learn more about the composition of ocean water or
seawater.
Fig. 3.1
2. Answer the following questions using figure 3.1:
19
Questions
Ocean water is also a source of food. Fish is the main catch. Modern
fishing vessels are now equipped with radar, echo sounds and even refrigerators
and other technologies to improve the fishing industry.
Do you also know that the oceans play an important role in our global
climate? How? The basic idea is a phenomenon called thermohaline
circulation. Due to density differences, a mass of low density (warmer or less
saline) water rises from below. This is replaced by a mass of water of greater
density (colder or more saline). This deep ocean circulation is a global happening.
It does not involve only a small mass of water. How are density and salinity
changed? Water at the surface of the oceans is made colder by heat loss to the
atmosphere. Through evaporation, some molecules of water at the surface
escape from the free surface of the water. When water evaporates, the salinity of
the remaining water becomes greater making the density greater. Water chilled
in the polar region becomes denser. It sinks and displaces warmer water.
20
Water also has a high heat capacity. It can store more energy than an
equal mass of other substances. This can also modulate climate.
Oceans are also home to small floating algae and other green plants,
making oceans a major storehouse of carbon dioxide. Carbon dioxide is one of
the greenhouse gases. Greenhouse gases absorb heat radiated from the earth’s
surface. Greenhouse effect keeps our atmosphere warm.
Directions: Get a pad paper and answer the following questions briefly
21
Growth in population
The world’s population is growing rapidly. The number of people and the
number of households using water are also increasing. The demand for water is,
therefore, increasing. A person needs water for drinking, for taking a bath, for
cooking and cleaning. Nowadays water is scarce not only in the Philippines, but
worldwide.
Think of how much water you consume in one day in doing the different activities
at home. Use Table 4.1 below in recording your data. Then, compute your water
consumption in one month.
22
Climate Change
The continued rise in the amount of carbon dioxide in the atmosphere is believed
to have caused an increase in the global temperature. This phenomenon is
termed global warming. Too much warming in polar latitudes has been
observed to melt enough glacier to cause the rising of sea level. Warming of
ocean water has also been observed to cause the expansion of seawater adding
to the increase in the level of seawater. However, there are many other factors
responsible to changes in climate other than global warming.
Many scientists believe that the building of cities worldwide has caused
changes in the amount of precipitation. In cities, cementing of roads decreases
the land areas covered with vegetation. Greater amount of precipitation become
runoffs instead of being absorbed in soils and rocks. Aside from flash floods,
another consequence of this increase in runoff is too much precipitation because
the amount of water that evaporates increases. The water cycle is shortened,
that is, water is exchanged between surface water and the atmosphere. You
might have observed that we now have more frequent storms.
23
This is about two-thirds of the Pasig River’s system’s total biological oxygen
demand (BOD) load. These wastes are responsible for the destruction of the
river’s aquatic life.
Eutrophication
24
What you will do
Self-Test 4.1
Get a pad paper and try answering the questions as best as you
can. If you have difficulty answering the questions, go over the lesson
again.
Let’s summarize
25
11. Oceans are the biggest bodies of water where water in steams and rivers
go.
12. Human activities affect the earth’s waters. These changes on the earth’s
waters, in turn, affect people on earth.
Posttest
I. Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer and write this on your
answer sheet.
26
II. Completion Type: Complete each of the following sentences with a word
or phrase .
5-6. Two physical changes, ____________ and ____________ are part of the
water cycle.
8. Water that soaks into the ground reaches a zone called ______________
where all the open spaces in rocks are completely filled with water.
27
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. c
2. c
3. a
4. d
5. a
6. a
7. d
8. c
9. a
10. a
Self-Test 1.1
1. The total volume of the world’s waters has always remained the same from the
time the earth was formed. This is due to a process called the hydrologic
cycle.
2. The two processes involved in the water cycle are evaporation and
condensation. Evaporation from surface waters brings water to the air.
Condensation of water vapor in the air brings back the water to the surface.
Self-Test 2.1
1. Groundwater is water that infiltrates the ground. It is water found
underground.
2. The source of groundwater is precipitation.
3. The factors that affect the movement of groundwater are porosity and
permeability of rocks or sediments, and the steepness of the water
table. Gravity helps pull the water downward.
4. The greater the porosity, the greater is the amount of groundwater that
may stay in spaces between rock particles. Rocks are more porous if
particles are well sorted, rounded, and loosely packed. The more
permeable the rock is, the faster the movement of groundwater.
Permeable rocks are those that have wide pores or the space between
particles is large, and whose pores are interconnected.
28
5. seawater
6. fresh water
7. seawater
Self-Test 3.1
1. Ocean is made salty by the presence of mineral salts carried to the oceans
from weathered rocks in the continents.
2. The major constituents of ocean water are chlorine, sodium, sulfate,
magnesium, calcium, and potassium.
3. The resources we can get from ocean water are dissolved minerals like salt,
magnesium, and bromine. It is also a source of food like fish.
4. Ocean water contains dissolved minerals like salt, magnesium and bromine.
Freshwater comes from groundwater that finds its way out of the ground in the
form of springs and wells. Freshwater unlike ocean water is a source of water for
human consumption.
Self-Test 4.1
1. The different issues related to the earth’s water are growth in population,
growing demand for food, climate change, contamination of existing water
supply, and excessive withdrawal of groundwater.
29
Posttest
I. 1. a
2. c
3. a
4. d
5. b
Completion
1. water
2. hydrosphere
3. polluted
4. water cycle
5. evaporation
6. condensation
7. groundwater
8. zone of saturation
9. water table
10. aquifer
-End of Module-
References
Tarbuck, E.J. and Lutgens F K. (2000). Earth Science (9th ed.). Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey:
Prentice Hall
Dutch, S.I. and Monroe J. S. (1998) Earth Science. Singapore: Wadsworth Publishing Company,
A Division of Thomson Learning
30
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 14
1
Module 14
The Earth’s Atmosphere
You have learned facts about the earth’s lithosphere and hydrosphere in your last
module. This module presents knowledge about the earth’s gaseous envelope - the
atmosphere. It includes the following lessons:
2
6. Perform all the activities diligently to help and guide you in understanding the
topic.
7. Take the self-tests after each lesson to determine how much you understood
the topic.
8. Answer the posttest to measure how much you have gained from the lessons.
4. An imaginary line that divides the places on the earth in an NORTH-SOUTH direction
is the:
a. equator
b. latitude
c. longitude
d. prime meridian
5. Which of the following statements describes the temperature in the troposphere and
stratosphere?
a. The troposphere is hotter than the stratosphere
b. The stratosphere is hotter than the troposphere
c. Low temperature exists in the troposphere and stratosphere.
d. The temperature in the troposphere is equal to the temperature of the
stratosphere.
3
6. Arrange the following layers of the atmosphere from the earth’s reference.
A - ozone layer a. A – B – C - D
B – stratosphere b. B – C – D - A
C – troposphere c. C – D – A - B
D - mesosphere d. C – A - B – D
COLUMN A COLUMN B
1. atmosphere a. layer of the atmosphere that is characterized by
an increase in temperature due to the
concentration of ozone
2. troposphere b. lowermost layer of the atmosphere that is
characterized by a decrease in temperature
with height
3. stratosphere c. layer of the atmosphere that is immediately
above the stratosphere
4. ozone layer d. it is called the “blanket of air
5. mesosphere e. it is the state of the atmosphere at a particular
place during a short period of time
6. air pollution f. it is caused by the earth-sun relationship
7. weather g. it is the condition of the atmosphere at a
particular location over a long period of time
8. climate h. formed through the process of precipitation
9. season i. it is the warming of the earth's surface
10. global warming j. it involves the release into the atmosphere of
gases, finely divided solids, or finely dispersed
liquid aerosols
4
Lesson 1 The Earth’s Grid System
Earth’s grid or coordinate system can be described and determined by means of
the position or location of any place on the Earth's surface.
LATITUDE
PRIME
MERIDIAN
EQUATOR
LONGITUDE
The two reference points in locating the places on earth are the equator and the
prime meridian.
The equator is also called the great circle around the Earth that is equidistant from
the geographic poles and lies in a plane perpendicular to the Earth's axis. It divides the
Earth into the Northern and Southern hemispheres and forms the imaginary reference line
on the Earth's surface from which latitude is considered. It is the line with 0° latitude
The prime meridian is the imaginary line used to indicate 0° longitude that passes
through Greenwich and terminates at the North and South poles. It is measured in degrees,
minutes, and seconds. It is used as the reference for all other meridians of longitude, which
are numbered east or west of it. This also serves as the basis for the world's standard time
zone system.
5
center of the earth to any point elsewhere on the Equator. Longitude is measured 180° both
east and west of the prime meridian. To locate longitudinal positions on a globe or map,
meridians are plotted and drawn from pole to pole where they meet. The distance per
degree of longitude at the Equator is about 111.32 km (69.18 miles) and at the poles, 0.The
combination of meridians of longitude and parallels of latitude establishes a framework or
grid by means of which exact positions can be determined in reference to the prime
meridian and the Equator.
Based on the discussion, identify the points (latitude and longitude) plotted on the
coordinate system. The first two points are identified for you. Write your answers on the
table provided for:
6
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
Study the diagram below. Identify the parts that are shown in the diagram. Fill up the
table below.
7
Lesson 2 The Earth’s Atmosphere
This lesson will guide you in understanding the earth’s atmosphere - the place on
earth that is vital to our existence. It will help you examine the ocean of air in which we all
must live.
The atmosphere, solar energy and our planet’s magnetic fields support life on Earth.
The atmosphere absorbs the energy from the Sun, recycles water and other chemicals, and
works with the electrical and magnetic forces to provide a moderate climate. The
atmosphere also protects us from high-energy radiation and the frigid vacuum of space.
The earth is a terrestrial body whose solid surface, abundant waters, and oxygen-rich
atmosphere have combined to create conditions suitable for life.
The earth is surrounded by a blanket of air that we call atmosphere. The atmosphere
is considered in terms of layers, or regions, arranged like spherical shells above the surface
of the Earth. It reaches over 560 kilometers (348 miles) from the surface of the Earth, so we
are only able to see what occurs fairly close to the ground. Early attempts at studying the
nature of the atmosphere used clues from the weather, the beautiful multi-colored sunsets
and sunrises, and the twinkling of stars. With the use of sensitive instruments from space,
we are able to get a better view of our atmosphere.
8
The atmosphere is primarily composed of nitrogen (N2, 78%), oxygen (O2, 21%), and
argon (Ar, 1%). A myriad of other very influential components are also present which include
the "greenhouse" gases or ozone (0 - 0.01%), carbon dioxide (CO2, 0.033%). (Refer to
Table)
The atmosphere extends from the surface of the Earth to heights of thousands of
kilometers, where it gradually merges with the solar wind. The composition of the
atmosphere as measured by its mean density (the average mass per unit volume) is more
or less constant with height to altitudes of about 100 kilometers. This state of approximate
uniformity arises as a result of motion and as a consequence of the high frequency with
which molecules of a particular species are involved in collisions with their neighbors. A
representative oxygen molecule, O2, for example, encounters a nitrogen molecule, N2, on
average once every 10-9 second at the surface. Even at heights of 100 kilometers, where
the density of air molecules is much lower, the encounter time is still comparatively brief,
about 10-3 second. A force imparted to one molecule is rapidly transferred to all. The
atmosphere tends to behave as though it were composed of a single molecular species with
an effective molecular mass set by its mean composition. The bulk of the lower atmosphere
is composed of N2 and O2, with relative abundances of, respectively, 0.78 and 0.21. The
region above 100 kilometers is referred to as the heterosphere, a name intended to
emphasize the importance of the change in composition as a function of altitude. In the
same vein, the region lower than 100 kilometers was given the name homosphere.
Choose any set of jumbled letters. Arrange the letters to form word/s that is/are
described by the following sentences.
9
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Label each division in the circle based on the percentage of gasses present in the
earth’s atmosphere.
10
The envelope of gas surrounding the Earth changes from the ground up. Four distinct
layers have been identified using temperature changes, chemical composition, movement,
and density. However, there are no distinct lines or boundaries where one layer ends and
the other begins.
The mesosphere is the "Middle sphere" and is the coldest layer of the atmosphere.
There are very few gases available in this layer to absorb the heat from the sun. The
mesopause is the upper boundary for this layer.
The stratosphere extends from the top of the tropopause to about 50 km (31 miles).
The temperature begins to increase in this layer because it contains the highest
concentration of ozone. Ozone absorbs the sun's heat and also protects us from the harmful
ultraviolet rays of the sun. The stratosphere is ideal for jets to travel in because they are
above the weather and the air is so "thin" that it offers little resistance to the aircraft. There is
no weather in this layer because there is no water vapor. The stratopause is the upper
boundary for this layer.
Although the greenhouse effect and the ozone layer both protect life on earth, they
are very different. While the greenhouse effect lets sunshine in and prevents the heat from
escaping, the ozone layer prevents harmful ultraviolet radiation from entering the
atmosphere. Ultraviolet radiation from the sun is what causes sunburns and skin cancer.
The layer of gaseous ozone in the upper atmosphere that blocks radiation is what we call
the ozone layer.
In the stratosphere, ozone is distributed all over the globe. It exists at concentrations
that would be deadly in the troposphere, which extends from the Earth’s surface to about 7
miles up. The ozone layer is not a thin band of concentrated gas. The ozone layer in the
stratosphere extends from about 7 miles up to about 30 miles.
The troposphere is the lowest layer of the atmosphere where all weather occurs. It is
the only layer that has both the moisture and instability necessary to produce clouds. The
troposphere extends upward about 6 km (3.7miles) at the poles, and as much as 16 km (10
miles} at the equator. The temperature decreases as one goes higher up. The tropopause, a
transition zone between the troposphere and the stratosphere, is where the jet streams are
found.
11
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
Identify the following: Write your answer on the space provided before the number:
_______________ 5. The two factors that are considered in determining the layers of the
atmosphere
Imagine that you are living 100 years ago. The air today is not as clean as it was 100
years ago. Years have passed and the age of industrialism and rise of technology gave rise
to this changing earth. Each year a huge amount of wastes is generated.
This lesson will help you understand how these changes affect the environment
particularly the air. This will help you answer the following basic questions:
12
The following paragraph discusses what causes seasons
Season is caused by the earth-sun relationship. It is any of four divisions of the year
according to consistent annual changes in the weather. The seasons—winter, spring,
summer, and autumn—are commonly regarded in the Northern Hemisphere as beginning
on the winter solstice, December 22 or 23; the vernal equinox, March 20 or 21; the summer
solstice, June 21 or 22; and the autumnal equinox, September 22 or 23. At the equinoxes,
the days and nights are equal in length; at the winter solstice the day is the year's shortest,
and at the summer solstice, the day is the year's longest. (See Figure 4.1)
Each year the earth experiences changes in its radiation budget, in the distribution of
heat input into the atmosphere and in the course of the seasonal migration of the Sun
between 23°N and 23°S. This is a result of seasonal change.
Why is there variation in season? The gradual change in daylight that occurs
throughout the year accounts for this difference. (See Figure 4.2)
13
Figure 4.2:
Rays striking at a low angle
travel through more of the
atmosphere than rays striking at
a higher angle and therefore are
subjected to greater depletion
due to reflection of sunlight.
The seasonal variation in the altitude of the sun affects the amount of energy
received at the earth’s surface in two ways. First, when the sun is directly overhead (90°
angle), the solar rays are most concentrated. The lower the angle, the more spread out and
less intense is the solar radiation that reaches the surface. (See Fig. 4.3). Second, the rays
of the sun determine the amount of atmosphere the rays must travel. (See Fig. 4.2). This
accounts for the fact that the midday sun can be blinding, while the setting sun can be a
sight to behold.
Figure 4.3 Changes in the sun angle cause variations in the amount of solar
energy reaching the earth’s surface. The higher the angle, the more intense
the solar radiation.
14
Weather and Climate
Weather
Does it amaze you how the weather influences your life? Most conversations begin
or end with comments about the weather. Weather is the state of the atmosphere at a
particular place during a short period of time. It involves such atmospheric phenomena as
temperature, humidity, precipitation (type and amount), air pressure, wind, and cloud cover.
Weather differs from climate in that the latter is the synthesis of weather conditions that
have prevailed over a given area during a long time period—generally 30 years. Weather
occurs in the troposphere. Although weather is largely confined to the troposphere,
phenomena of the higher regions of the atmosphere such as jet streams and upper-air
waves significantly affect sea-level atmospheric-pressure patterns—the so-called highs and
lows—and thereby the weather conditions at the terrestrial surface. Manifestations of such
weather-affecting interactions between the ocean and the atmosphere are what scientists
call the El Niño and La Niña.
Climate
Climate is the condition of the atmosphere at a particular location over a long period
of time; it is the long-term summation of the atmospheric elements (and their variations) that,
over short time periods, constitute weather. These elements are solar radiation,
temperature, humidity, precipitation (type, frequency, and amount), atmospheric pressure,
and wind (speed and direction). To the general public the word retains the meaning of
expected or habitual weather, which is heavily dependent on place and time of year. Climate
is now perceived as part of a larger system that includes the atmosphere but also the
hydrosphere (all liquid and frozen surface waters), the lithosphere (all solid land surfaces,
including the ocean floors), the biosphere (all living things), and such extraterrestrial factors
as the Sun.
15
Forecasters in weather forecasting use the following weather tools.
Thermometer - an instrument
used to measure temperatures.
Mercury inside the thermometer
rises or falls as it expands or
contracts from changes in
temperature.
16
Anemometer - A tool used to
measure wind speed.
plastic cups
barbeque stick
B. Try your improvised anemometer. Place it outside the house where there is enough
wind. Install it in a way that it can’t be thrown by the strong wind.
C. Observe the movement of the instrument.
D. From your observation, tell what the weather is.
17
E. Forecast the weather for two days.
F. Verify your answers by watching TV for weather reports.
Clouds are made of small droplets of water or bits of ice that are spread out from
each other. Rain falls when the drops get too big and heavy to stay in the cloud. There are
three main kinds of clouds. What are these?
Directions
Look outside and see if there are any clouds in the sky today.
Draw pictures of the clouds
Tell what the weather is like.
Using the pictures, find the cloud that most closely matches those you have seen
and drawn.
Compare your drawing with the pictures of the clouds below.
Write down the name of the cloud.
18
Different Kinds of Clouds
Cirrus Clouds
19
Cumulus Clouds
Stratus Clouds
20
Greenhouse effect is the warming of the earth's surface and lower atmosphere that
tends to intensify with an increase in atmospheric carbon dioxide. The atmosphere allows a
large percentage of the rays of visible light from the sun to reach the earth's surface and
heat it. A part of this energy is reradiated by the earth's surface in the form of long-wave
infrared radiation, much of which is absorbed by molecules of carbon dioxide and water
vapor in the atmosphere and which is reflected back to the surface as heat. This is roughly
analogous to the effect produced by the glass panes of a greenhouse, which transmit
sunlight in the visible range but hold in heat. The trapping of this infrared radiation causes
the earth's surface and lower atmospheric layers to warm to a higher temperature than
would otherwise be the case. Without this greenhouse heating, the earth's average
temperature would be only about -73° C (-100° F); even the oceans would be frozen under
such conditions. Owing to the rise in atmospheric carbon dioxide caused by modern
industrial societies' widespread combustion of fossil fuels (coal, oil, and natural gas), the
greenhouse effect on earth may be intensified and long-term climatic changes may result.
An increase in atmospheric concentrations of other trace gases such as chlorofluorocarbons
(Freons), nitrous oxide, and methane, due again largely to human activity, may also
aggravate greenhouse conditions. A growing number of scientists have predicted that
significant alterations in climate patterns will be seen by the turn of the century. They
estimate that global average temperatures could increase by as much as 5° C (9° F) by the
middle of the 21st century. Such global warming would cause the polar ice caps and
mountain glaciers to melt rapidly and result in appreciably higher coastal waters. The rise in
global temperature would also produce new patterns and extremes of drought and rainfall,
seriously disrupting food production in certain regions.
21
The Ozone Hole
The ozone layer is not of the same thickness all around the Earth. The ozone hole
refers to areas of the ozone layer that are so thin that cannot block as much radiation as
thicker parts. When the ozone layer thins to 50 percent of its normal thickness, that area is
called an ozone hole.
The ozone hole is caused by the breakdown of certain chlorine and/or bromine
compounds (called chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) or halons). These compounds are
commonly used as a coolant in refrigerators and air conditioners, in foam manufacturing and
as fire extinguishing agents.
Ground-level ozone, often called smog, is a harmful air pollutant that irritates the
lungs and damages the leaves of plants. The difference between the ozone in the ozone
layer and harmful ground-level ozone is the location of the ozone in relation to people,
plants and animals. Ozone in the ozone layer is so high above ground that it cannot reach
people, plants and animals and cannot harm them. However, ozone at ground level is close
enough to breathe.
Air Pollution
Air pollution involves the release into the atmosphere of gases, finely divided solids,
or finely dispersed liquid aerosols at rates that exceed the capacity of the atmosphere to
dissipate them or to dispose of them through incorporation into solid or liquid layers of the
biosphere. Air pollution results from a variety of causes, not all of which are within human
control. .Air pollution may affect humans directly, causing a smarting of the eyes or
coughing. Pollution continued to increase as a result of the increased number of motor
vehicles. Exhaust fumes from the engines of automobiles contain a number of polluting
22
substances, including carbon monoxide and a variety of complex hydrocarbons, nitrogen
oxides, and other compounds. When acted upon by sunlight, these substances undergo a
change in composition producing the brown, photochemical smog. Efforts to reduce
pollution from automobile engines and to develop pollution-free engines may eventually
eliminate the more serious air pollution problems. Air pollution has a serious effect and has
caused respiratory distress, particularly in children, elderly people, and those suffering from
respiratory diseases.
The two main sources of pollutants in urban areas are transportation (predominantly
automobiles) and fuel combustion in stationary sources, including residential, commercial,
and industrial heating and cooling and coal-burning power plants. Motor vehicles produce
high levels of carbon monoxides (CO) and a major source of hydrocarbons (HC) and
nitrogen oxides (NOx). Whereas, fuel combustion in stationary sources is the dominant
source of sulfur dioxide (SO2).
Carbon Dioxide
Carbon dioxide (CO2) is one of the major pollutants in the atmosphere. Major
sources of CO2 are fossil fuels burning and deforestation. CO2 is a good transmitter of
sunlight, but partially restricts infrared radiation going back from the earth into space. This
produces the so-called greenhouse effect that prevents a drastic cooling of the Earth during
the night. Increasing the amount of CO2 in the atmosphere reinforces this effect and is
expected to result in a warming of the Earth's surface. Currently carbon dioxide is
responsible for 57% of the global warming trend. Nitrogen oxides contribute most of the
atmospheric contaminants.
23
Sulfur and chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs)
Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs)
Smog
Photochemical smog is created by burning coal and heavy oil that contain sulfur
impurities in power plants, industrial plants, etc. The smog consists mostly of a mixture of
sulfur dioxide and fog. Suspended droplets of sulfuric acid are formed from some of the
sulfur dioxide, and a variety of suspended solid particles. Smog's unpleasant properties
result from the irradiation by sunlight of hydrocarbons caused primarily by unburned
gasoline emitted by automobiles and other combustion sources. The products of
photochemical reactions includes organic particles, ozone, aldehydes, ketones,
peroxyacetyl nitrate, organic acids, and other oxidants. Ozone is a gas created by nitrogen
dioxide or nitric oxide when exposed to sunlight. Ozone causes eye irritation, impaired lung
function, and damage to trees and crops. Another form of smog is called industrial smog.
24
Self-Test 4.1
Direction: Draw a line that connects the statement on the left with the statement on
the right:
25
from changes in
temperature.
13. It is a tool used to measure p. barometer
the direction the wind
14. It is a tool used to measure q. anemometer
the atmospheric (air)
pressure which is then used r. thermometer
to forecast the weather.
15. It is a tool used to measure s. stratus clouds
the amount of humidity or
moisture in the air. The t. nimbus clouds
higher the humidity, the
more moisture is in the air
16. It is a tool used to tell wind
speed.
17. These are very high, u. cumulus clouds
wispy clouds made of ice.
Even in the summer, cirrus v. cirrus clouds
clouds are made of ice
because it is cold high above w. rain
Earth.
x. wind vane
18. These are large clouds;
look like huge puffs of cotton.
Sometimes these clouds look
like animals or familiar things.
19. These clouds tell us that
it will rain
20. These clouds are made
up of low layers of clouds that
usually cover the whole sky
and blot out the sun.
26
Let’s summarize
27
Posttest
1.
2.
3.
4.
10. The warming of the earth’s atmosphere due to the presence of too much carbon
dioxide is called __________.
17. An imaginary line that divides the places the earth in an EAST-WEST direction is the:
a. Equator b. latitude c. longitude d. prime meridian
20. An imaginary line that divides the places the earth in a NORTH-SOUTH direction is the:
a. Equator b. latitude c. longitude d. prime meridian
28
21. Which of the following statement describes the temperature in the troposphere and
stratosphere?
a. The troposphere is hotter than the stratosphere
b. The stratosphere is hotter than the troposphere
c. Low temperature exists in the troposphere and stratosphere.
d. The temperature in the troposphere is equal to the temperature of the
stratosphere.
22. Arrange the following layers of the atmosphere from the earth’s reference.
A - ozone layer a. A – B – C - D
B – stratosphere b. B – C – D - A
C – troposhere c. C – D – A - B
D - mesophere d. C – A - B – D
24. Which part of the atmosphere protects us from harmful ultraviolet rays?
a. ozone layer b. stratosphere c. troposhere d. mesosphere
29
Key to Answers
Pre-test: A. 1. c B. 1. d
2. a 2. b
3. d 3. c
4. b 4. a
5. a 5. c
6. d 6. j
7. b 7. e
8. a 8. g
9. d 9. f
10. c 10. i.
Activity 1.1:
Self-Test 1.1
30
Activity 2.1
OXYGEN
NITROGEN ARGON
Self-Test 3.1
1. atmosphere
2. troposphere
3. ozone layer
4. mesosphere
5. altitude and temperature
Posttest:
1. longitude 8. stratosphere 19. a
2. prime meridian 9. ozone layer 20. b
3. equator 10. mesosphere 21. a
4. latitude 11. greenhouse effect 22. d
5. 23.5° 12 – 14. season, weather, climate 23. b
6. atmosphere 15 – 17. CFCs, CO, CO2, NOx, SO2 24. a
31
7. troposphere 18. c 25. d
References
Coble, C.R., et. Al. (1991). Earth Science. New Jersey, U.S.A.: Prentice Hall
Tarbuck, E.J. and F.K. Lutgens. (1995). Earth Science. Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey, U.S.A.: Prentice Hall
32
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 15
1
Module 15
Planets in the Solar System
Have you ever wondered what lies beyond earth? Try to look at the sky at night.
What are the things that you see? You probably have seen the moon and the stars. Some
bright objects in the sky are the other planets. Sometimes we see meteors and comets.
Would you like to learn more about them? Come, let us explore the Solar system.
This module will help you find out many things about our solar system. There will be
activities prepared for you to help you understand our lesson much better. Self-tests are
also provided for you for a good look at your progress. Have fun and enjoy learning the
following lessons:
2
3. Check your answers against the correct answers provided at the last page of the
module.
4. Be very honest in taking the test so you know how much knowledge you already
have about the topic.
5. After taking the pre-test, different lessons about the solar system are provided for
you.
6. Perform all the activities, as these will help you have a better understanding of the
topic.
7. Self-tests are also available at the end of each lesson for you to determine how
much you remember about the lesson.
8. Before the end of this module a simple 10-item multiple-choice test is prepared for
you.
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a separate
sheet of paper.
1. All the solar system planets could easily fit on the inside of ...
a. Jupiter
b. Saturn
c. Uranus
3. Olympus Mons, the largest active volcano in the solar system, is found on Mercury.
a. True
b. False
5. Of all the planets in the solar system, which is the closest to the Earth in terms of size
and mass.
a. Mars
3
b. Mercury
c. Venus
d. Pluto
4
Lesson 1 The Origin of the Solar System
Try this! Match the scientist to the theory and view attributed to him. Draw a
line, which will connect one to the other.
Ptolemy
There were two different views about our solar system. Ptolemy, a famous
astronomer, once said that earth is the center of the solar system and everything moves
around it. This idea is known as the geocentric view of the solar system. Geo means earth
and centric means center. His idea was anchored on the fact that man is known to be
created like God thus he must be very close to God.
Coppernicus, on the other hand, is one great man who opposed Ptolemy’s theory. He
said that the sun is the center of the solar system and revolving around it are the planets.
This is known as the heliocentric theory (helio –fire and centric – center). Now who do you
think has a better idea?
Read this!
5
The orderly nature of our solar system is believed by astronomers to have formed 5
billion years ago. The planets, the sun and all other members of the solar system are
believed to have formed at the same time from a vast cloud of dust and gases called nebula.
This concept is called the nebular theory of the solar system
Answer this!
How do planets in the solar system move? For thousands of years, people have
watched the stars at night. The stars appear to rise and set slowly as the night goes on.
These stars are like our sun, which can make their own light.
From night to night, some points of light seem to move along with the stars. These
points of light are the planets. Like our
planet – the Earth, the moons and other
planets do not make their own light. They
only reflect the light from the sun.
for Pluto. Now try this one. Get Figure 1.2. The Solar System
6
a chair and move around it. While moving around the chair, turn around. Your motion
around the chair is like the motion of all the planets around the sun. This is called revolution.
One complete revolution of a planet means one complete year of the planet. On the other
hand, when you turn around in one place, the motion is basically called rotation. All planets
in the solar system rotate about their own axis (axis - an imaginary line running across the
planet on which the planet turns about). One complete rotation is equivalent to one whole
day in the planet.
Identify the planet located on the orbits based on the time for 1 revolution
1 2.
3
4
5
Oops! Before you go on, try this one!
7
What you will do
Self-Test 1.1
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a separate
sheet of paper.
5. People once believed that all planets and stars orbited around ____.
a. Mercury
b. Venus
c. Earth
d. Mars
Key to answers on page 26
You may now proceed to the next lesson. If you score below 3 you need to go back
and read the lesson again!
8
Lesson 2 Sun: The Center of the Solar System
Did you know that the sun is not really located at the center of the planets’ orbit?
Take a look at the orbit of Earth. Earth follows an elliptical path and the sun is located at one
of the foci.
Do you know how big the sun is? The sun is 140
000 km in diameter. Compared to other stars, the sun is
a medium-sized star. The Earth’s diameter is about
13000 km. More than 100 Earths could fit in a line along
the sun’s diameter and it would take over a million earths
to fill the entire space taken up by the sun.
Do you know how earth and the organisms like us make use of sun’s energy to
maintain life? Plants need sunlight for photosynthesis to exist. Photosynthesis is the
process of making food by plants. For evaporation to occur, sunlight, which provides enough
amount of energy, is needed. Evaporation is a change of phase from liquid like water to gas
9
like water vapor. Other organisms need sunlight for them to be able to maintain constant
body temperature. Temperature is the hotness or coldness of a body. People like us need
sunlight for our skin to produce vitamin D, which is essential to living. Other countries make
use of sunlight as their main source of energy. They make use of solar cells or solar panels
to collect sunlight and convert this energy to electrical energy that can light their houses,
cook their food, and iron their clothes, and wash their clothes. What about you, how can you
make use of sunlight?
Here’s a simple activity that can give you an idea how you can make use of solar
energy for practical purposes
Materials
large bowl
aluminum foil
plastic knives or spreaders
paper plates and napkins
Peanut butter (refrigerated)
cheese
crackers
stop watch
Procedure
1. Make a solar oven by lining the inside of a large bowl with aluminum foil. Place a glob of
cold peanut butter on the bottom of the bowl, and position the bowl in direct sunlight so
that the sun's rays are shining on the inside of the bowl. You may need to use blocks to
prop the bowl at an angle to catch the rays.
2. Let the bowl sit for about an hour and regularly check the melting progress. Then spread
the melted peanut butter on crackers and serve for a simple picnic treat.
3. Put a slice of cheese on one cracker and some stiff peanut butter on another. Predict
which will melt first. Then find other items to melt, such as an ice cube, crayon, and
candle. Record on a chart the time it takes each item to melt, and compare your
predictions.
10
Data and Results
Guide Questions:
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a separate
sheet of paper.
11
2. The surface temperature of a yellow star is about _____________.
a. 600oC
b. 6000 oC
c. 60000oC
Check your answers against the answer key provided on page 25. If you score 3 or
more out of 5 – Congratulations! You may now proceed to the next lesson. If you
score below 3 you need to go back and read the lesson again!
12
photosphere, which is about 550 kilometers thick. It is the layer that emits the sun’s light.
The chromosphere is the layer of the sun’s atmosphere next to the photosphere. It is
believed to be responsible in emitting the color of the sun. The corona is the last layer of the
sun’s atmosphere. It is also known as the crown of light that surrounds the sun. (Corona
comes from the Latin word meaning crown). The corona is the layer of the sun’s atmosphere
farthest from the sun. The temperature in the corona is more than 1 million degree Celsius.
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a
separate sheet of paper.
1. The layer of the sun’s atmosphere next to the photosphere is the ____________.
a. corona
b. chromosphere
c. solar sphere
3. Which among the following is the layer of the sun’s atmosphere that is responsible for
emitting white light?
a. Photosphere
b. Chromosphere
c. Corona
4. Which layer of the sun’s atmosphere is farthest away from the sun?
a. Photosphere
b. Chromosphere
c. Corona
13
If you score 3 or more out of 5 – Congratulations! You may now proceed to the
next lesson. If you score below 3 you need to go back and read the lesson again!
There are basically nine members of the solar systems. Our nine planets are grouped
into two: the terrestrial planets (innermost planets), which include Mercury, Venus, Earth
and Mars and the Jovian planets (outermost planets), which include Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus
and Neptune. Pluto is the ninth planet in the solar system. It was neither classified as a
terrestrial nor a Jovian planet because of its characteristics. The tenth planet in the solar
system is named after Dr. Josette Biyo, a Filipino teacher who won the Intel Excellence in
Teaching award in USA.
Label the planets starting from the one closest to the sun.
14
Remember this!
Here’s an easier way of remembering the planets starting from the one closest
to the sun!
Now let’s take a close look at the different planets of the solar system. The four
planets closest to the sun are known as the inner planets. Often times they are also called
terrestrial planets since all of them appear solid and they look like our very own planet – The
Earth!
15
hot at daytime with a temperature of about 427oC, hot enough to melt tin and lead! You
could probably have 3rd degree burns or worse if you go there without life support.
Consequently, no life has ever been discovered in Mercury.
Did you also know that Mars has moons or natural satellites? They are named as
Phobos and Deimos. It is believed that these moons are asteroids captured by Mars!
16
What you will do
Activity 3.2 The Jovian Planets
17
Saturn: The Ringed Planet
Saturn is known to be the most elegant planet in the
solar system because of its rings which are very visible to the
eyes. It circles the sun in about 29.46 Earth years. Thus, one
complete year in Saturn is about 29.46 years on earth.
Saturn’s rings were first seen by Galileo in 1610. Recent
discoveries confirm that these rings are made up of ice rocks.
At present, Saturn has about 21 natural satellites, the most
prominent of which is known as Titan.
Neptune is the outermost planet of the gas giants. It has an equatorial diameter of
49500 kilometers (30760 miles). If Neptune were hollow, it could contain nearly 60 Earths.
Neptune orbits the Sun every 165 years. It has eight moons, six of which were found by
Voyager. A day on Neptune is 16 hours and 6.7 minutes. Neptune was discovered on
September 23, 1846 by Johann Gottfried Galle, of the Berlin Observatory, and Louis
d'Arrest, an astronomy student, through mathematical predictions made by Urbain Jean
Joseph Le Verrier.
The first two thirds of Neptune is composed of a mixture of molten rock, water, liquid
ammonia and methane. The outer third is a mixture of heated gases comprised of hydrogen,
helium, water and methane. Methane gives Neptune its blue cloud color. Neptune has a set
of four rings, which are narrow and very faint. The rings are made up of dust particles
thought to have been made by tiny meteorites smashing into Neptune's moons.
18
Pluto: The God of the Underworld!
Pluto was discovered in 1930. The uniqueness of
Pluto's orbit, rotational relationship with its satellite, spin
axis, and light variations all give the planet a certain appeal.
Pluto is usually the farthest planet from the sun; however,
due to the eccentricity of its orbit, it is closer than Neptune
for 20 years out of its 249-year orbit. Pluto crossed
Neptune's orbit on January 21, 1979, made its closest
approach on September 5, 1989, and will remain within the
orbit of Neptune until February 11, 1999. This will not occur
again until September 2226. Pluto's rotation period is 6.387
days, the same as its satellite Charon. Pluto rotates with its
poles almost in its orbital plane. Pluto's rotational axis is
tipped 122 degrees.
Properties
Planets Distance
Size Orbit/Period No. of Moons Temperature
form the sun
Mercury 2
Venus 4
Earth 5
Mars 3
Jupiter 9
Saturn 8
Uranus 6
Neptune 7
Pluto 1
19
What you will do
Activity 3.4 New Planet
Read this!
Dr. Josette Biyo is a public school teacher from Iloilo who won the Intel Excellence in
Teaching award in the US, besting 4000 candidates from all around the world. The
Massachusetts Institute of Technology Lincoln Laboratory in Boston named a minor planet
(Planet 13241) in her honor.
Answer this!
1. What do you think is the name of the newest member of the solar system? _______
2. Where is it located? __________________________________________________
Find all the words listed below. You can do this by crossing out the word horizontally,
vertically or diagonally.
Biyo LPLUTOKCNHVAZXL
Charon PAXKTXUJFELEMLP
Earth LNIUFFWONYPANHV
Ganymede ALARJUPITERTSUN
Jovian NNFITSUNARUAUBS
Jupiter EOADVSSRAMTQMNS
Mars TREEZOEVBUWYBOE
Mercury
SAADEKJRRWRIBVT
Phobos
Planet
IHRERGFNRUCOYIZ
Pluto PCTMKOWZCEHKTQP
Saturn XQHYHXYRNPTARTZ
Terrestrial EIDNSHEIDQNAHRU
Titan LNPACMULBEUSBJJ
Uranus TYWGLCGZGGMPTGC
ZBXTSCLGZLHKTMG
20
What you will do
Self-Test 3.1
A. Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write your answer on a separate
sheet of paper.
2. Which among the following are known as the outermost planet in the solar system?
a. Jupiter, Venus, Saturn, Pluto
b. Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, Neptune
c. Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, Pluto
d. Jupiter, Saturn, Neptune, Pluto
3. Which of the following was known as Planet X before it was completely discovered?
a. Uranus
b. Neptune
c. Mercury
d. Pluto
21
8. Which of the following statements is true?
a. Helium gives Neptune its blue cloud color
b. Water gives Neptune its blue cloud color.
c. Methane gives Neptune its blue cloud color.
1. Saturn's density is so low that the entire planet could float in water.
2. Earth's axis of rotation is almost parallel to the plane of its orbit.
3. Venus experiences an intense greenhouse effect.
4. Io, the largest moon to Saturn, is volcanically active.
5. Galileo discovered that the orbits in which planets move around the Sun are elliptical.
6. Ganymede is a volcano on the planet Jupiter
7. The surface of Mars has long channels that may have been caused by flowing water.
8. The innermost planet in the solar system is called Pluto.
9. The outer planets are small, rocky planets with iron cores.
10. Charon is a satellite of Venus.
If you score 15 or more out of 20 – Congratulations! You may now proceed. If you
score below 7 you need to go back and read the lesson again!
22
Let’s summarize
1. There were two (2) different views about the solar system:
The Geocentric view coined by Ptolemy, claims that earth is the center of the
solar system.
2. The nebular theory was proposed as the basis of origin of the solar system, it states
that the solar system came from clouds of dust and gasses called nebula which
rotates faster and faster as the particles move toward each other to the center
forming what is now known as the sun.
4. It can produce its own light and energy by the process known as thermonuclear
fusion in which 4 hydrogen nuclei combine to form a helium nucleus with an excess
matter, which is converted to an amount of energy given off by the sun.
5. It has several layers such as the photosphere, the chromosphere, and the corona.
The sun’s energy is utilized in different ways and processes such as in
photosynthesis, and the production of vitamin D by organisms.
8. The nine planets are grouped into two: the terrestrial planets (innermost planets),
which include Mercury, Venus, Earth and Mars and the Jovian planets (outermost
planets), which include Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus and Neptune.
9. Pluto is the ninth planet in the solar system. It was neither classified as a terrestrial
nor a Jovian planet because of its characteristics.
10. The tenth planet in the solar system is named after Dr. Josette Biyo, a Filipino
teacher who won the Intel Excellence in Teaching award in USA in 2001
23
Posttest
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a separate
sheet of paper.
1. Of all the planets in the solar system, which is the closest to the Earth in terms of size
and mass.
a. Mars
b. Mercury
c. Pluto
d. Venus
2. The Sun, a yellow star emits its own light through a process known as thermonuclear
fusion. What does thermonuclear fusion mean?
a. Splitting of an object.
b. Splitting of a nucleus.
c. Combining of an object.
d. Combining of nuclei.
24
b. The Moon is at the center of a heliocentric system.
c. The Earth is at the center of a heliocentric system.
d. None of the above.
8. Which among the following are known as the outermost or the Jovian planets?
a. Jupiter, Saturn, Neptune, Pluto
b. Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, Pluto
c. Jupiter, Saturn, Mars, Uranus
d. Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus, Neptune
25
Key to Answers
Pre-Test
1. a
2. b
3. a
4. a
5. b
6. b
7. b
8. a
9. a
10. c
Lesson 1
Activity 1.1. Theories about the Solar System
Earth –
Heliocentric
Centered Solar
Theory
system
Copernicus
Sun – Centered Geocentric
Solar system Theory
Ptolemy
Activity 1.2
1. The solar system is about 5 billion years old.
2. It is believed that the solar system formed form a nebula: cloud of dust and
gases.
3. The nebula rotated at a constant speed that caused it to form a disk-shaped
material, which is the sun. Then the gases that remained formed the planets.
Activity 1.3
1. Mercury
2. Venus
3. Earth
4. Mars
5. Pluto
26
Self-Test 1.1
1. b 4. b
2. a 5. c
3. b
Self-Test 2.1
1. b 4. c
2. b 5. b
3. a
6.
Self-Test 2.2
1. b 4. c
2. b 5. a
3. a
e. Mercury
f. Venus
g. Earth
h. Mars
i. Jupiter
j. Saturn
k. Uranus
l. Neptune
m. Pluto
27
Activity 3.3. The Planets
Properties
Planets No. of Distance form
Size Orbit/Period Temperature
Moons the sun
Mercury 2 1 1 1 8
Venus 4 2 2 2 9
Earth 5 3 3 3 7
Mars 3 4 5 4 6
Jupiter 9 5 8 5 5
Saturn 8 6 9 6 4
Uranus 6 7 6 7 3
Neptune 7 8 7 8 2
Pluto 1 9 4 9 1
Self-Test 3.1. A
1. d 6. c
2. b 7. a
3. b 8. c
4. c 9. b
5. c 10. c
28
Self-Test 3.1. B
1. ☺
2.
3. ☺
4.
5.
6.
7. ☺
8.
9.
10.
Post Test
1. b
2. c
3. d
4. b
5. d
6. b
7. a
8. d
9. c
10. a
________________________________________________________________
References
Tarbuck, E.J. and Lutgens, F.K. (1994). Earth Science 7th Edition. Englewood, CA:
Prentice Hall
29
Module 16
Sun, Earth and Moon
1
How to learn from this module
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write your answer on a separate
sheet of paper.
1. In what particular orbit do the planets like earth travel around the sun?
a. circular orbit
b. elliptical orbit
c. rectangular orbit
d. none of the above
2
2. The earth is closest to the sun at ________________.
a. Perihelion
b. Aphelion
c. Apogee
d. Perigee
3. Which of the following is the reason why planets like Earth maintain their orbit around
the sun?
a. Tidal force between the sun and the planets.
b. Magnetic force between the sun and the planets.
c. Gravitational force between the sun and the planets.
d. Electrostatic force between the sun and the planets.
6. Which among the following causes the changes in the length of day or changes in
season?
a. Sun’s rays
b. Earth’s tilt
c. Phases of the moon
d. None of the above
7. The time it takes for the moon to rotate along its axis once is ______________.
a. 27 1/3 days
b. 24 hours
c. 30 days
d. 365 days
3
9. Which of the following is the best description of the moon?
a. The moon is a constellation. Mars and Jupiter.
b. The moon is an asteroid that is located between.
c. The moon is a star because it is bright at nighttime.
d. The moon is a satellite that revolves around a planet.
10. The phases of the moon depend on the position of the _______________.
a. earth only
b. moon only
c. earth and moon only
d. earth, moon and sun
11. How long does it take the moon to go through all of its phases?
a. 24 hours
b. 27 1/3 days
c. 29 ½ days
d. 1 year
12. What phase of the moon does an observer on earth see when the moon is located
between the planes of the sun and the earth?
a. New moon
b. Full moon
c. First quarter moon
d. Last quarter moon
4
Lesson 1 How the Earth Moves
Objectives:
1. To make a model of the earth.
2. To observe how earth moves about its own axis.
Materials:
plastic-foam ball, flashlight and barbecue stick
Procedure:
1. Get a plastic-foam ball and a barbecue stick. Push the stick to the center of the ball.
Hold one end of the barbecue stick and turn the ball from right to left. Observe the
motion of the ball about the stick.
2. Switch on the flashlight and focus the light to the model earth as you rotate your
model earth in a counterclockwise direction. Write down your observations.
5
Observations:
Guide Questions:
6
What you will do
Activity 1.2 Light on Earth
In the picture below, which part of the earth has daytime? Which part has nighttime?
Label the part of the earth that experiences daytime with “DAY”. Label the part of the earth
that experiences nighttime with “NIGHT”.
The part of the earth that experiences daytime is the one that faces the sun. The
sun’s energy serves as the free source of light for this part of the earth. The part of the
earth, which does not receive sunlight, experiences nighttime. At night, the sky appears dark
since the place where you live is turned away from the sun. One daytime and one nighttime
together make one complete day. The length of time for one complete rotation is one full
day. On earth, one full day is divided into 24 hours. Because of the rotation of the earth, you
often see the sun rising in the east and the sun setting in the west.
Your life is very much affected by the rotation of the earth. As the earth rotates, your
body follows a cycle of sleeping and waking. As soon as you wake up tomorrow morning,
rotate your head 10 times. Then rotate you hips 10 times. These make a good exercise.
7
What you will do
Activity 1.3 Making Models
Objective:
To observe how earth moves about the sun.
Materials:
plastic-foam ball, flashlight and barbecue stick
Procedure:
Switch on the flashlight and focus the light to the model earth as you move your model earth
around the flashlight. What do you observe?
Observations:
Guide Questions:
3. What is responsible in keeping the earth on its orbit around the sun?
8
As the earth rotates on its axis, it also moves around the sun. This movement of the
earth around an external axis (the sun) is called revolution. The path, which the earth
takes as it revolves around the sun, is called orbit. Just like all the planets, except Mercury,
the earth follows an elliptical (egg-shaped) path. Johannes Kepler is one of our
astronomers who said that the planets follow an elliptical path around the sun. One full orbit
of the earth around the sun is called one complete revolution. To make one complete
revolution the earth travels about 365¼ days around the sun. The earth rotates slowly and
at the same time it revolves very slowly that we do not feel the movement.
What keeps the earth in its orbit? What keeps it from flying off in a straight line into
space? The earth continues to revolve around the sun maintaining its orbit because of
gravity. The gravitational attraction between the earth and the sun forces the earth to
change its direction. The gravitational force keeps the earth from moving in a straight line
into the space. This keeps the earth moving in an elliptical orbit from west to east.
Gravitational attraction between 2 objects was discovered by one of the greatest scientist in
the 17th century, Sir Isaac Newton. The fall of an apple on his head was the root of this
discovery.
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a
separate sheet of paper.
1. If you were in Copernicus’ place and you contradicted the idea of Ptolemy that the
earth was the center of the universe, what evidences would you present to convince
people that the sun was the center of the Solar system?
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
__________________________________________________________________________
9
2. Write the appropriate connecting word or words in the concept map below.
Earth Sun
Elliptical Orbit
Day and Night
causes (example)
Rotation
If you answer the concept map correctly– Congratulations! You may now
proceed to the next lesson. If not, you need to go back and read the lesson again!
10
Lesson 2. Seasons of the Earth
Are days and nights of the same length? Do you notice some changes in the length
of day during summer and during Christmas season? Usually, during summer the sun rises
very early and sets very late. While during Christmas season, the sun rises late and it sets
early. This means that daytime is longer during summer months and shorter during
Christmas season. Do you know why these changes in season happen?
Objective:
1. To observe how changes in daytime happen.
Materials:
Model earth and flashlight, protractor
Procedure:
1. Get your model earth tilt it by about 23.5o from the vertical axis.
2. Switch on the flashlight and focus the light to the model earth as you revolve your
model earth around the flashlight (sun).
Guide Questions:
1. Do all the places of the earth, which faces the sun, receive the same amount of light?
2. What do these differences in the amount of sunlight received by the different places
on earth faces the sun mean?
3. If the Earth’s Northern Hemisphere is tilted towards the sun, what is the season in the
Northern Hemisphere? In the Southern Hemisphere?
4. If the earth is neither tilted towards or away from the sun what season will probably
occur?
11
The earth turns on its own axis (axis of rotation) but it does point straight upward. The
axis of the earth is tilted at an angle of 23 ½ o from the vertical axis. One end of the axis is
called the North Pole while the other end is called the South Pole. The North Pole of the
earth points directly towards the North Star called the Polaris.
If the earth’s axis were not tilted, daytime and nighttime would always be equal.
Figure 2.1 shows what that would be like. All the lines will receive the same amount of light
thus experiences equal daytime and nighttime. But since the earth’s axis is tilted, day and
night are not always of the same length. Figure 2.1 shows the earth’s tilt and the amount of
light different places on earth that face the sun receive. Only the equatorial region receive
uniform amount of sunlight and,
thus have equal daytime and
nighttime. The upper portion from
the equatorial region receives more
light than the lower portion. These
areas experience longer daytime
than nighttime. Conversely, the
areas below the equatorial region
experience longer nighttime than
daytime. North Pole is all in
daylight, while the South Pole is a
24-hour total darkness. Days and
Figure 2.2. Seasons on Earth nights have different lengths
because of the earth’s tilt.
Historically, 4 days each year have been given special significance based on the
position of earth’s sunlight with respect to the sun and its relation to the yearly weather
cycle. On June 21 or 22 the earth is in a position such that the axis in the Northern
Hemisphere is tilted 23-½ o toward the sun (figure 2.2). At this time the vertical rays of the
sun strike the 23-½ o north latitude (23 ½ o north of the equator), a line of latitude known as
the Tropic of Cancer. People in the Northern Hemisphere usually label June 21 or 22 as
summer solstice. These are usually known as the days with the longest daytime. Summer
is usually from June to March. Six months after, on December 21 or 22, the earth is in the
opposite position, with the sun’s vertical rays striking at 23-½ o south latitude. This line is
12
known as the Tropic of Capricorn. For those in the Northern Hemisphere, December 21 or
22 is the winter solstice. These are the usually known as the days with the longest
nighttime. Thus winter comes from December to September.
The equinoxes occur midway between the solstices. September 22 or 23 is the date
of the autumnal equinox in the Northern Hemisphere, and March 21 or 22 is the date of the
vernal equinox. On these date, the vertical rays of the sun strike directly at the equator
because the earth is in such a position in its orbit that the axis is tilted neither toward nor
away from the sun. Incidentally, the point at which earth is closest to the sun is known as
perihelion and the point where earth is farthest from the sun is known as aphelion.
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write the chosen letter on a
separate sheet of paper.
13
d. West
5. Which among the following causes the changes in the length of day?
a. Sun’s rays
b. Earth’s tilt
c. Phases of the moon
d. None of the above
Are you familiar with the show Marina? Marina is a girl cursed to be a mermaid by a
wicked witch named Victoria who happens to have a daughter named Luna. Did you know
that our moon is also named Luna? The moon is the only natural satellite of the earth. A
satellite is an opaque (objects that absorb light and produces shadows) object that revolves
around another object.
14
What you will do
Activity 3.1 Making Models
Objective:
1. To make a model of the moon.
2. To observe how moon moves about its own axis and about the earth.
Materials:
Model earth, Styrofoam ball (smaller than the model earth in size), cutter and sand
paper.
Procedure:
1. Get the Styrofoam ball and make holes on its surface using a cutter. Polish your
model moon using the sandpaper.
2. Get your model earth and make the model moon revolve around it while you
rotate the model moon. See to it that while you let the model moon rotate and
revolve around the model earth, the model earth sees the same part of the moon
throughout the motion.
Guide Question:
Take a look at the picture of the moon again. You can see that the moon has many
holes. These holes are called craters. The moon has no
atmosphere to protect it from colliding with other
heavenly bodies.
15
According to most astronomers, the period of revolution (time for one revolution-29 ½
days) and the period of rotation (time for one rotation-27 1/3 days) of the moon are the
same. This is due to the fact that while the moon rotates and revolves around the earth, the
earth also rotates and revolves around the sun. Thus, when the moon has completed its
rotation, its revolution is not yet completed because the earth has already changed its
position with respect to the sun. This makes the moon take additional days to complete the
revolution. If not for the movement of the earth around the sun then both the rotation and
revolution of the moon around the earth will be completed in 27 1/3 days. This makes us see
only one face of the moon all the times.
Have you seen the moon change its shape in a month? Although the moon is really
shaped like a ball, its shape appears to change from day to day. This change in its shape is
called the phases of the moon. Figure 3.3 shows the phases of the moon.
Objective:
1. To observe how moon reflects the light of the sun.
Materials:
Procedure:
16
Model Moon
Observations:
Guide Question:
1. Where do you think does the moon get its light, which serves as our moonlight
during nighttime?
The brightness of the moon provides light at night. But the moon does not produce its
own light. It is an opaque body. As such it cannot produce its own light. Moonlight is really
sunlight reflected by the moon. When the moon is between the earth and the sun it is called
new moon (see figure 3.4). In a new moon, the moonlight is just a sunlight reflected by
earth to the moon. This moonlight is called earthshine. While during full moon, when the
earth is between the sun and the moon, the moonlight is the light from the sun reflected by
the moon to the earth (see figure 3.5).
Model Earth
Flashlight
Model Moon (sun’s rays)
17
What you will do
Activity 3.3 Moon’s Phases
Objective:
1. To observe the phases of the moon
Materials:
Procedure:
Observations
M
S
E
S
E
M
S
E
18
S
M E
S
E
M
S
E
S
E M
Guide Question:
19
Look at the picture of the phases of the moon (figure 3.6). After a few days, the moon
takes another position. At this time, you
can see a thin slice of the moon on the
western sky just after sunset. This is called
the crescent moon. In the next few days,
the moon appears bigger. You can see
half of the lighted side. This is called the
first quarter. This is visible from about
noon to midnight. Then the moon grows
bigger than the first quarter moon. The
shape is called gibbous moon. In a few
days, when the moon is nearly opposite
the sun, the side facing the moon is fully
lighted. This is the full moon phase. After
the full moon phase, the moon becomes
smaller (wanes) until it disappears. It starts
Figure 3.6. Moon’s Phases as a new moon again.
1. How much time does it take for the moon to go through all its phases?
2. What happens when the moon’s period of rotation and period of revolution is the
same?
3. When you look at the crescent moon early in the evening, is the moon waxing
(growing) or waning (decreasing)?
If you answered 2 out of 3 correctly– Congratulations! You may now proceed to the
next lesson. If not, you need to go back and read the lesson again!
20
Lesson 4 Eclipses
What would you do if it suddenly becomes dark in the middle of a clear sunny day?
Would you be frightened? Don’t be! This is just a natural event. It usually takes place when
there is a solar eclipse.
Objective:
1. To observe the solar eclipse.
Materials:
Procedure:
1. Get your model moon, model earth, and a flashlight. Position the 3 objects as
shown in Figure 4.1
21
Guide Questions:
2. If you were on the spot on earth where the moon has blocked sunlight, what
would you observe?
What happens when the moon is between the sun and the earth? The moon absorbs
the sunlight preventing it from reaching the earth. This produces a shadow of the moon on
the earth’s surface. The shadow of the
moon on the earth’s surface is called an
eclipse of the sun. This is known as
solar eclipse. A solar eclipse occurs
during new moon because in a new-
moon phase, the moon is between the
sun and the earth. But solar eclipses do
not always occur every new moon. In
fact it occurs very rarely.Look at figure
4.1. The moon is in its new moon phase
but since the moon, the sun and the Figure 4.2 Solar Eclipse
earth are not positioned in a straight line
then there will be no solar eclipse.
Figure 4.2 shows the moon casting a dark shadow on earth. How does this shadow
affect earth? The places on earth that will be covered by the umbra (darkest part of the
moon’s shadow) will experience a total solar eclipse.
In a total solar eclipse, the moon covers the bright surface of the sun and only the
sun’s corona can be seen. During this time, the sky darkens, and the planets and stars can
be seen. A total eclipse lasts only about seven minutes or less.
Partial solar eclipse occurs in places on earth reached by the penumbra (the lighter
part of the shadow) of the moon’s shadow. An eclipse is a natural event. View it without fear.
22
Remember this!
Do not look directly at the sun during a solar eclipse. The radiation can damage
your eyes. It can even lead to blindness. You can use an old X-ray film or an old
filmstrip to view the sun and protect your eyes from the radiation. Or you may also use a
basin of water to see the magnificent event.
There are usually four eclipses occurring in each year. These come as a set of one
solar eclipse and one lunar eclipse, followed six months later with another set. A total solar
eclipse has occurred in our country several times. The most recent of which is that which
occurred on October 24, 1995 at Tawi-Tawi.
Objective:
1. To observe the solar eclipse.
Materials:
Procedure:
1. Get your model moon, model earth, and a flashlight. Position the 3 objects as
shown below.
Model Moon
Model Earth Flashlight
(sun’s rays)
23
Guide Questions:
What happens when the earth is between the moon and the sun? The earth blocks
the sunlight from reaching the moon. When this happens, a lunar eclipse (eclipse of the
moon) occurs. This usually happens
during a full moon since at that time,
the earth is between the moon and the
earth. A lunar eclipse and it usually
occurs for four hours only occurs when
the moon, the sun and the earth are in
a straight line. It can be seen by
anyone on the side of the earth facing
Figure 4.4. Lunar Eclipse the moon. These occur as a set of one
solar eclipse and one lunar eclipse in a
period of 6 months.
24
What you will do
Self-Test 4.1
Direction: Answer the following very logically. Write your answer on a separate sheet
of paper.
1. When the moon is between the earth and the sun, what kind of eclipse occurs?
a. Solar eclipse
b. Lunar eclipse
5. When the moon is between the earth and the sun, what kind of eclipse occurs?
a. Solar eclipse
b. Lunar eclipse
25
Let’s summarize
1. Earth revolves around the sun in an elliptical path and at the same time that it
rotates about its axis.
2. Revolution is the movement of the earth around an external axis (the sun)
4. Rotation is the movement of the earth around its internal axis. One rotation is
equal to 24 hours.
5. Gravitational force is the force responsible for maintaining the earth’s orbit around
the sun.
6. The length of the day changes because the earth is tilted by about 23 ½ o from the
vertical axis.
9. Luna, our moon is a natural satellite of the earth. It has marias and highlands.
10. Changes in the moon’s shape as it appears on earth are called the phases of the
moon.
11. Basically the 4 basic phases are the full moon, new moon, first quarter and last
quarter.
12. Eclipses occur when the sun, the moon and the earth lie along one line.
13. Lunar eclipse usually occurs during a full moon phase when the earth is between
the moon and the sun.
14. Solar eclipse occurs when the moon is between the sun and the earth
26
Posttest
Direction: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write your answer on a
separate sheet of paper.
3. Which of the following is the reason why planets like Earth maintain their orbit around the
sun?
a. Tidal force between the sun and the planets.
b. Magnetic force between the sun and the planets.
c. Gravitational force between the sun and the planets.
d. Electrostatic force between the sun and the planets.
4. The day on which the sun reaches its greatest altitude at noon is
a. summer solstice.
b. winter solstice.
c. vernal equinox.
d. spring equinox
5. The time when the sun crosses the celestial equator is called a/an
a. equinox
b. summer solstice
c. winter solstice
d. None of the above
6. Which among the following causes the changes in the length of day?
a. Sun’s rays
b. Earth’s tilt
c. Phases of the moon
e. None of the above
27
c. 1 as much
6
d. None of the above
11. If a solar eclipse occurred 2 weeks ago, what would be the phase of the moon today?
a. first quarter
b. full
c. last quarter
d. new
15. When the moon is between the earth and the sun, what kind of eclipse occurs?
a. Solar eclipse
b. Lunar eclipse
28
Key to Answers
Pre-Test
1. b
2. b
3. c
4. b
5. c
6. b
7. a
8. c
9. d
10. c
11. c
12. c
13. c
14. b
15. a
Activity 1.1
Activity 1.2
daytime
nighttime
29
Activity 1.3
Self-Test 1.1
1. Sun rise and sun set are evidences that earth is rotating on its axis and
revolving around the sun.
2.
Which
Earth revolves Sun
around
on in an
Elliptical Orbit
Day and Night
causes
Rotation
Activity 2.1
Guide Questions:
30
Self-Test 2.1
1. a
2. d
3. b
4. c
5. b
Activity 3.1
Guide Question
1. Earth represents the moon’s axis of revolution.
Activity 3.2
Observation
Earth reflects sunlight to the moon which in turn reflects it to
the earth in the form of moonlight.
Guide Question
Moonlight comes from the earth’s reflected sun rays –
earthshine
Activity 3.3
Observations
S M
E Full moon
Third quarter
S
E
31
M Waning Crescent
S
E
New Moon
S
M E
S Waxing Crescent
E
M
S First Quarter
E
S Waxing Gibbous
E M
Self-Test 3.1
1. 29 ½ days
2. We will see only one side of the moon forever
3. waxing
32
Activity 4.1
Guide questions
1. Moon casts a shadow on earth
2. darkness
3. Usually solar eclipse occurs when the moon is between the earth and the
sun lying along one line.
Activity 4.2
Guide questions
1. Moon will cast a shadow on earth during nighttime.
2. Usually lunar eclipse occurs when the earth is between the moon and the
sun lying along one line.
Self-Test 4.1
1. a
2. b
3. b
4. a
5. a
Post Test
1. a
2. b
3. a
4. a
5. a
6. a
7. b
8. b
9. a
10. a
11. b
12. a
13. c
14. c
15. d
-End of Module-
33
References
Bernstein, L. et.al. (1986). Concepts and challenges in Earth Science (2nd Ed.) NY: Globe
Book Company, Inc.
Tarbuck, E.J. Lutgens, F.K. (1994). Earth Science (7th Ed.) Englewood, CA: Prentice Hall
Photo Credits:
34
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 17
1
Module 17
Minor Members of the Solar System
This module will take you on a fly-by tour outside the earth, providing you a
closer look at the asteroids, meteors and comets. You and I will experience this one of
a kind adventure. Come with me and have fun learning the following lessons:
1. explain the occurrence of comet, meteor showers and other phenomena; and
2. identify technologies used in studying other heavenly bodies and their uses
on Earth.
I know you are excited to start the adventure just as I am but remember to do the
following tips to successfully achieve the objectives of this self-learning kit.
2
What to do before (Pretest)
Before we proceed, let us see if you can answer these simple questions about
our lesson. For each item, encircle the letter of the correct answer.
3. A meteorite is
a. a rock from space that strikes the ground
b. a piece of rock passing through the earth’s atmosphere
c. the trail left by a piece rock as it passes through the earth’s atmosphere
d. all of the above
4. Most of the asteroids orbit the sun in a belt between the orbits of
a. Venus and Mars
b. Mars and Earth
c. Mars and Jupiter
d. Jupiter and Saturn
3
7. Why are meteorites and comets important in studying the origin of the solar system?
a. They have recently formed themselves.
b. They are recently produced fragments of planets.
c. They represent the material which formed the planets.
d. None of the above
8. The orbits of most comets, which we see in the inner solar system
a. are nearly circular
b. are highly elliptical
c. never come closer to the sun
d. are only slightly inclined to the earth’s orbit
4
14. The first space probes to successfully land on the surface of Mars were
a. IRAS and Galileo
b. Hubble Telescopes
c. Viking 1 and 2
d. Galileo and Viking 1
Trying to scan the entire sky on moonless nights over and over again, looking for
changing objects against the static background of stars, have you ever wondered what
lies beyond? I am sure you will be amazed to know that there are other minor bodies
that could possibly affect our lives on earth.
Asteroids
Asteroids are simply rocky or metallic objects that orbit the sun in the same way
that planets orbit. Asteroids are hard to see because they reflect little light and they are
always on the move. None of the asteroids has an atmosphere.
5
Where do many asteroids orbit?
Many asteroids orbit the sun in a region between Mars and Jupiter. This area is
called the asteroid belt. They follow a slightly elliptical path as they orbit the sun in the
same direction as the planets.
Yes, you’re right! A larger object such as a planet may pull an asteroid out of
orbit. And once an asteroid is captured by the gravitational pull of a planet, it may
become a satellite of that planet. Many astronomers believe that the two satellites of
Mars, Phobos and Deimos, are captured asteroids.
What prevents the asteroids in the belt from moving towards the sun and hitting
the inner planets, including our Mother Earth?
Ask your parents, aunts or lola if they have heard an old song from the 50’s
called “Catch a falling Star and Put it in Your Pocket”. What is a falling star? Can you
catch it? Will it really fit in your pocket?
Like asteroids, meteoroids collide and can be pulled out of orbit or sent into
earth’s atmosphere or another planet.
6
So what happens when a meteoroid enters earth’s atmosphere?
When a meteoroid enters the earth’s atmosphere, friction between this object
and atmospheric gases heats it to the point that it glows and becomes visible to our
eyes for only a few seconds. This streak of light in the sky is known as meteors,
sometimes called falling or shooting stars.
What if the meteor does not burn up completely? Would it fall to the earth?
If the meteor does not burn up completely, the remaining portion falls to earth!
But don’t worry; you are still lucky because most of them are very small. In addition,
most debris from space falls unseen over oceans or sparsely populated areas like
Antarctica. A meteor that hits the earth’s surface is called a meteorite.
Do you have any idea how many meteorites hit the earth each year?
Based from the scientists’ record, meteorites constantly hit the Earth’s surface.
The table below will give you an idea of the approximate size and number of meteorites
that hit the Earth’s surface.
There has only been one report of an “HBM” (hit by meteorite). In 1954, a
meteorite, which weighed 19.84 kilograms, crashed through the roof of Ann Hodges of
Sylacauga, Alabama. Do you know what happened to her? Thank God she was just
slightly injured!
Comets
People have been aware of comets since ancient times. Try to ask your lola or
lolo about comets, and they might tell you that a comet brings bad luck! Why?
Some people believed that comets were bad spirits who took on the appearance
of the head of a woman with its long hair streaming behind. To old folks, this was a
traditional sign of mourning. Sometimes, to other people, a comet appeared as a
sword, a sign of war, death and famine.
7
Did you know?
The Hoba iron meteorite is the largest single meteorite known. It can still be
found in its landing sight in Namibia. Its present weight is estimated at 66,000
kilogram. Part of the Hoba has rusted away. Therefore, its original weight may have
been as much as 100,000!
8
Where do they come from?
Most comets are thought to originate from a huge cloud called the Oort Cloud,
which is too far away for astronomers to see.
There is no evidence that a comet has ever crashed into earth. However, it is
one possible explanation for the extinction of dinosaurs. The hypothesis is that a large
comet or asteroid crashed into our planet and triggered a chain of disastrous events
like earthquakes, tidal waves, causing radical changes in the climate and eventually
wiped out dinosaurs.
Meteor showers and storms occur when the earth passes through a comet’s
orbit, and leftover comet debris bombards the earth. Meteor showers occur at a
predictable time each year. The latest meteor shower experienced on earth happened
in November 1999. It was named Leonid shower.
When a comet approaches the sun, the tail is behind the head, but as it travels
away from the sun, the tail is in front. In other words, the comet’s tail always points
away from the sun. This is due to the effect of the solar winds.
9
What you will do
Activity 1.1
After exploring the amazing asteroids, comets, and meteors, test yourself if you
can differentiate the three:
A if it refers to comets
B if it refers to meteors
C if it refers to asteroids
D if it refers to both comets and meteors
E if it refers to both meteors and asteroids
F if it refers to both asteroids and comets
G if it refers to all (comets, meteors and asteroid)
Characteristics:
___1. Progress across the sky very slowly ___11. Known as falling stars or
shooting stars
___2. Remnants of the formation of the solar ___12. They glow as they enter earth’s
system atmosphere
___3. Reflect sunlight ___13. Streak across the sky very fast
___4. Rocky composition ___14. Come in all sizes and shapes
___5. Orbit the sun in highly elliptical orbits ___15. Icy objects
___6. Minor planets ___16. Meteor showers
___7. Mostly found between Mars and Jupiter ___17. Tail always point away from the
sun
___8. Can reach 150 million km in length ___18. Travel in a variety of orbits
___9. Most have slightly elliptical orbits ___19. Known as falling stars or
shooting stars
___10. Result from the collision of asteroids
10
What you will do
Activity 1.2
Direction: To demonstrate the various components in a comet and see how the tail
forms, you can make a simple model using either of the following options:
1. Cut slits in the paper from each corner leaving a space in the middle (like the
drawing).
2. Lay the strips across the paper over the slits to make an "X."
3. Put a piece of tape across the "X" to hold the strips on to the paper.
4. Crumple the paper into a comet shape. Make sure that your strips stay on the
outside.
5. Use the scissors to poke a hole through the comet.
6. Push the straw into the hole.
7. Hold the comet by the straw.
8. Use a hairdryer to show how the Sun's energy makes parts of the comet blow off
to a tail. (Let the adult plug the dryer into the socket.)
9. Here is something you can do with a friend. He or she can be the Sun. Walk
around the Sun holding the comet. The Sun's energy should blow on your comet
as you walk.
10. See how the tail moves as you get closer to the Sun.
11
Option 2.
What you need:
In a large mixing bowl add one cup of water, 1/2 cup garden soil with pebbles,
1/4 cup dark corn syrup (for organics), 1/4 cup dilute ammonia (for gas) and a pinch of
iron filings. Stir the mixture well and add 2 cups of crushed, dry ice. YOU MUST WEAR
GLOVES ! As the mixture starts to freeze, squeeze some of it together like you were
packing a snowball and presto, you have a comet nucleus. Place the frozen mass on a
plate and have the students observe it sublimate. To get a tail, you'll need to create the
"solar wind". This can be accomplished by using a standard blow dryer turned on high
pointed at the comet.
12
Lesson 2 Space Technology
Come with me and find yourself a seat in one of these robotic machines…
Remember to fasten your seatbelt, we are about to launch! One…two…three…
Hubble Space Telescope is one of the largest and most complex satellites ever
built. It was named after American astronomer Edwin P. Hubble, who first discovered
that countless island cities of stars and galaxies dwell far beyond the Milky Way.
The Infrared Astronomical Satellite (IRAS) was launched in January 1983. Its
mission was to map the entire sky at infrared wavelengths. IRAS was the first satellite
to discover a comet.
The Near Earth Asteroid Rendezvous (NEAR) is the first of NASA’s discovery
missions and the first mission to go into orbit around an asteroid. Studies were made of
the asteroids’ size, shape, mass, magnetic field, composition, and surface and internal
structure. The spacecraft has the shape of an octagonal prism, approximately 1.7 meter
on a side, with four solar panels and a fixed 1.5-meter X-band high gain radio antenna.
It is equipped with an X-ray/gamma ray spectrometer, a near-infrared imaging
spectrograph, a laser altimeter, and a magnetometer.
13
Vikings 1 and 2 became the first space probes to successfully land on the
surface of Mars. It was the first US spacecraft to successfully touch down on any planet
other than Earth.
Mariner 10 was the first space probe to visit Mercury and the first to visit two
planets – Venus and Mercury.
StarDust was the first space probe sent to intercept and collect contents from a
comet’s tail.
Galileo spacecraft was the first to fly past an asteroid and the first to discover a
moon of an asteroid. It provided the only direct observation of a comet colliding with a
planet.
The Voyager probes, launched in the early 1970’s, are sending back information
about the outer solar system. These probes have given us a close up look at all the
planets and asteroids. Some of these probes have gone through the tails of comets.
Our fascination with our neighbor Mars has led to the invention of Mars
Pathfinder, Mars Global Surveyor, Mars Odyssey and Mars Rovers. These robotic
machines were sent to gather data regarding Mars’ surface features, atmosphere, and
magnetic properties. The objectives of these missions include the search for water and
for evidence of life-sustaining environments.
There are over eight thousand artificial objects orbiting Earth. From this
figure, over 2,500 are active satellites sending data back to earth, while others are
now inoperative. The remaining objects are orbital debris such as lens, hatch
covers, rocket bodies, payloads that have disintegrated or exploded, and even
objects that "escape" from manned spacecraft during operations.
14
What you will do
Activity 2.1 Robots: Just Like You!
You have learned that spacecrafts are complex, technological objects that have
to function far from Earth in the harsh environment of space. They have a common
function, which is to collect scientific data and send them back to Earth. What are the
basic parts of a spacecraft? What are the functions of these parts? To help you answer
these questions, let us try to compare spacecraft parts with your own body parts.
15
Now, match the human body parts in column A with its analogous spacecraft parts in
column B. Write the letter of your answer before each number.
b. Fuel lines
2. Body/Torso
c. Solar panels (sunlight), batteries
3. Brain (stored energy), radioisotopes
thermoelectric generators (heat
from the decay of radioactive
4. Nerves material)
j. Computers
16
What you will do
Activity 2.2
Can you identify some technologies used in astronomy? Name each picture
below.
A space vehicle that takes off like a rocket, orbits Earth like
a spaceship, and lands like an airplane.
It has a huge payload bay in which cargo, such as space
probe, is carried into space.
17
This satellite was a joint scientific project sponsored by the
United Kingdom, the United States, and the Netherlands. Its
mission was to map the entire sky at infrared wavelengths. It
was the first satellite to discover a comet.
Source: http://starchild.gsfc.nasa.gov/docs/StarChild/shadow/space_level1/wardrobe.html
18
Let’s summarize
What are the things that you have learned from this module?
1. Asteroids are rocky or metallic objects that orbit the sun in the same way that
planets orbit. Asteroids are hard to see because they reflect little light and
they are always on the move. Since they are smaller than planets, they are
often called minor planets or planetoids. Many asteroids orbit the sun in a
region between Mars and Jupiter. This area is called the asteroid belt. They
follow a slightly elliptical path as they orbit the sun in the same direction as
the planets.
2. Comets are fuzzy, luminous big dirty snowballs composed of rock dust
wrapped around a big ball of ice. Comets do not produce energy and light.
The coma envelops and hides the nucleus from our view. The nucleus is the
center of the comet made of frozen water. The nucleus and the coma
together are called the head of the comet.
5. A meteorite is a meteor that does not burn up before impacting with the
Earth’s surface.
6. Spacecrafts are complex, technological objects that have to function far from
Earth in the harsh environment of space. They collect scientific data and
send them back to Earth.
19
Posttest
After what you have been through with this module, I am very sure you can
now perfectly answer the following questions. For each item encircle the letter of
the correct answer.
1. Most of the asteroids orbit the sun in a belt between the orbits of
a. Venus and Mars
b. Mars and Earth
c. Jupiter and Saturn
d. Mars and Jupiter
3. A meteorite is
a. a rock from space that strikes the ground
b. a piece of rock passing through the earth’s atmosphere
c. the trail left by a rock as it passes through the earth’s atmosphere
d. all of the above
6. Why are meteorites and comets important in studying the origin of the solar system?
a. They have recently formed themselves.
b. They are recently produced fragments of planets.
c. They represent the material which formed the planets.
d. none of the above
20
7. Comet tails are the result of
a. interplanetary material streaming into the comet
b. melting and evaporation of ice from the comet core
c. dust collected by the comet as it moves in its orbit
d. solar wind blowing more gases from the central comet core
8. Meteors are
a. falling stars
b. signals from the other worlds
c. solar wind particles captured by the earth’s magnetic field
d. luminous trails left by small extraterrestrial particles rapidly passing through the
air
9. The orbits of most comets, which we see in the inner solar system
a. are nearly circular
b. are highly elliptical
c. never come closer to the sun
d. are only slightly inclined to the earth’s orbit
11. The first space probes to successfully land on the surface of Mars were
a. IRAS and Galileo
b. Hubble Telescopes
c. Viking 1 and 2
d. Galileo and Hubble Telescopes
21
14. Meteorites are composed of
a. hydrogen ice
b. helium ice
c. heavy elements like silicon
d. all the above
22
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. A 7. C 12. D
2. D 8. B 13. A
3. A 9. C 14. C
4. C 10. D 15. A
5. A 11. C
6. D
Activity 1.1
1. F
2. G
3. F
4. E
5. A
6. C
7. C
8. A
9. C
10. B
11. B
12. B
13. B
14. E
15. A
16. D
17. A
18. B
19. B
Activity 1.2 and 1.3 The students have the options which procedure to follow in
making model of comet.
23
Self-test 1.1
Activity 2.1
1. C
2. I
3. J
4. D
5. E
6. A
7. B
8. G
9. F
10. H
Activity 2.2
1. Hubble telescope
2. Apollo 11
3. Space shuttle
4. Space suit
5. Infrared Astronomical Satellite (IRAS)
6. Mariner 10
Self-test 2.1
Views of students may vary. Different people value space exploration for
different reasons.
Some people are not in favor of manned space flights because according
to them there is no evidence that this will do anything to contribute to our
understanding of planets outside our own.
Some people believe that it is a waste of billions of dollars sending
humans into space, where all they do is add weight and risk to space flights.
Anyway, most of our understanding of the cosmos has come from unmanned
space flights.
24
Those who are in favor for manned space flights wish to discover
minerals, which are scarce on earth. Some wish to use space as a manufacturing
site or a place to hide from tyranny.
Posttest
1. D 6. C 11. C
2. A 7. D 12. C
3. A 8. D 13. A
4. D 9. B 14. C
5. A 10. D 15. A
-End of Module-
References:
Dutch, S., Monroe, J., & Moran, J. (1998). Earth Science USA; Wadsworth Publishing
Company.
Tarbuck, E., & Lutgens, F., (1991). Earth Science.( 6th ed.) U.S.A. Macmillan
Publishing Company.
25
(Effective and Alternative Secondary Education)
INTEGRATED SCIENCE I
MODULE 18
Department of Education
DepED Complex, Meralco Avenue
Pasig City
1
Module 18
Beyond the Solar System
I know you are excited to learn the lessons just as I am but remember
these tips to help you achieve the objectives of this self-learning kit.
2
What to do before (Pretest)
Multiple Choice: Write the letter of the best answer before each number.
___1. How far away in light years is our nearest star, Proxima Centauri?
a. 2.2
b. 4.3
c. 5.5
d. 6.0
a. nuclear fision
b. nuclear fusion
c. star explosion
d. nitrogen combustion
3
___7. Most astronomers agree that the stars are born within huge clouds of dust
and gases called
a. sun
b. pulsars
c. auroras
d. nebulae
___8. The actual amount of light or brightness given off by a star is called
a. parallel shift
b. apparent magnitude
c. absolute magnitude
d. none of the above
___10. Which of the following units is used in measuring the distance of a star
from the earth?
a. mile
b. inch
c. kilometer
d. light year
4
___14. Which of the following describes the constellation Ursa Major?
a. lion
b. fish
c. dragon
d. big bear
When was the last time you’ve recited this poem? Though little is known
about these glittering objects in the sky, that has not stopped poets and writers
from writing beautiful poems and stories about these deep-sky objects.
What is a star?
A star is an enormous glowing ball of hot gas. There are billions of stars
contained in the galaxies of the universe. The Milky Way is the galaxy where our
solar system belongs. All the individual stars you see in the night sky are
members of our galaxy.
5
A star is born
Maybe you are wondering how a star is formed. Aside from billion of stars,
all galaxies contain huge clouds of gas and dust called nebulae. According to
scientists, it is in a nebula where a star is born.
The formation of a star starts when hydrogen gas is pulled into the
spinning clouds of nebula. As the clouds spin, the atoms of the hydrogen gas
collide. With this, friction heats other gases in the cloud and the temperature in
the center of the cloud rises. This give rise to a protostar. The protostar starts to
expand and contract. The temperature reaches a point where nuclear fusion
begins to take place. Nuclear fusion is the reaction that converts hydrogen
atoms into helium atoms releasing a tremendous amount of heat, causing the
gas to glow. When the mass at the center becomes stable, it now becomes the
main-sequence star that will continue to glow for millions or billions of years.
After perhaps billions of years, the nuclear fuel of a star, which is the
hydrogen, runs out. When this happens the star expands while the core
contracts. The star now begins to glow red.
The star is considered old when it has reached the red giant phase that
eventually explodes and turns into a dim, cool object. The collapse and explosion
of a not so big star is called nova, while the explosion of a massive star is called
supernova. However, some red giant stars undergo a nonexplosive fashion.
These stars become planetary nebulae.
Well, the destiny of a star depends on how massive it is. When the last of
the hydrogen gas in the outer shell of a star have a mass equal to or less than
the mass of the sun, it becomes a white dwarf. A white dwarf star is extremely
dense and shines with a white, hot light. When a star that has a mass equal to 2
or 3 times the mass of the sun runs out of hydrogen, it becomes a neutron star.
A neutron star is an extremely dense star composed of tightly packed neutrons
formed by the welding together of protons and electrons. The more massive the
star is, the more dramatic its end will be. A massive star that has a mass equal to
3 to 4 times the solar mass becomes a black hole when no nuclear fuel is
available to support its core. A black hole is a region in space where light cannot
6
escape. According to studies made, a black hole swallows any matter or energy
that comes near it.
Do you know that stars do not twinkle? They seem to twinkle when we see
them from the earth’s surface. The light of the stars is bent or refracted as it
travels through the thick layers of the earth’s atmosphere. This bending of light
results in the twinkling of the stars.
Think twice! During daytime we cannot see any star other than the Sun.
Yes, our own sun is a star. This is the nearest and brightest star to earth. This is
the only star we can see during the day. As the Sun lits up the sky, more light is
coming from the sky than from the stars. But though you can’t see other stars
during the day, it does not mean they are not there.
Other than the sun, the Proxima Centauri is the nearest star to earth. It is
4.3 light years away from earth. A light year is the standard unit of distance for
deep sky objects. It is the distance light travels in a year, or about 10 trillion
kilometers.
To give you an idea of how far Proxima Centauri is, let us say you will go
there with a speed of 300, 000 kilometers per second, which is the speed of light.
At this speed, it will take you more than 4 years and 3 months to reach the place.
Listed below are some stars with their distances from earth.
7
example, a star of magnitude 1 is brighter than a star of magnitude 2. While a
star of magnitude -2 is brighter than a star of magnitude -1.
Looking at the sky on a clear night, you might notice that stars have
different colors. Some stars look red, while most look whitish or bluish. You may
use binoculars to see the colors more clearly.
Did you know that the color of the star indicates its temperature?
Astronomers can determine the surface temperature of a star by measuring its
color. They use different methods in determining the temperature of stars. One
method is the use of an instrument called photometer. A photometer consists of
three filters that transmit light in three different wavelength ranges. Then the
scientists compare the two neighboring wavelength bands to determine which is
brighter and they convert the color relationships to temperature. Blue stars are
hotter than red stars. Rigel is an example of a bright blue star while Betelguese is
a bright red star.
8
What you will do
Activity 1.1
Part 1. Direction: Rank each of the following pictures by age, going from
youngest to oldest. Put a 1 in the blank by the picture you think is the youngest
person, a 2 in the blank by the second youngest, and so on.
Part 2. Direction: Rank each of the following pictures of BIG stars from birth
formation to stellar death. Put a 1 in the blank by the picture you think is the
youngest star, a 2 in the blank by the second youngest, and so on.
9
Large star. A
celestial mammoth Orion Nebula Betelguese star. A red
that releases up to surrounded by disk of supergiant. ______
10 million times the dust and gas ______
power of the sun
________
Question:
What was your basis of classifying the pictures
(persons and stars) by age? Explain the life cycle of
a star.
SOURCE:
http://btc.montana.edu/ceres/html/LifeCycle/images/M16Eagle.jpg
10
What you will do
Activity 1.2 Glittering Stars
This craft makes a beautiful picture of a night sky. The stars in our galaxy
are represented by the glitter (or sand).
Materials needed:
Procedure:
C. Sprinkle glitter (or sand) on each star. You may use different colors of
glitters for each star. Tilt the paper onto some newspaper to shake off the
loose glitter (or sand).
1. Scientists use a unit called light year to measure really long distances. Light
travels at 186,000 miles per second (300,000 kilometers per second), therefore,
a light second is 186,000 miles (300,000 kilometers). A light year is the distance
that light can travel in a year. Calculate the exact number of miles in a light-year?
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
11
2. Suppose the fastest spacecraft travels at 300, 000 kilometers per second. How
long would it take such a spacecraft to reach Sirius, which is 8.6 light years away
Earth?
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________
Have you gone one night on a stargazing session? If you have, you must
have seen patterns in the sky that look like a lion or a fish. Have you wondered
what they are? You are correct! Those are special groups of stars known as
constellations.
12
Why would people want to invent constellations?
Are you excited now to have another stargazing session? I’m sure you
are! But before you go, as a beginner you have to bring with you a star map or
sky map. The sky map shows the entire sky as viewed from a given location at a
specified time and date. The sky map will tell you which of the constellations are
visible to you at this time of year. But remember that constellations in the sky are
not exactly the same as the constellations in your star map. You may ask your
teacher where to get a copy of a sky map for the specific time and date you want.
I’m sure she is willing to help!
The Big Dipper or the Great Bear is one of the most well known star
groups. Actually, the Big Dipper is not really a constellation, but an asterism. An
asterism is a more recognizable part of a larger constellation. The Big Dipper is
a part of Ursa major constellation.
Most of the constellations are visible to the naked eye under good weather
conditions. However, if you are living in the city, the brightness of city light may
not allow you to see all the stars. The use of binoculars will make the stars look
more impressive.
Once you have with you a copy of a sky map, with or without binoculars,
you can now look for a good stargazing place. The city is still a good place to
view the sky. Since only the brighter stars can be seen, you will be able to find
the constellations easily.
If you think you are having difficulty searching for star patterns then
concentrate on the circumpolar stars because they are always above the horizon.
They are called circumpolar because they appear to circle the north celestial pole
every night. Take a look at these circumpolar stars.
13
Cepheus
Cassiopeia
14
How do you describe the Big Dipper? the little Dipper? Do they really look
like bears? Look at the constellation Cassiopeia. Does it look like a queen’s
crown? How about Cepheus? Does it look like a king? Well, you can make your
own constellation using your own imagination! Good luck and have some fun!
The zodiac names we use today are actually the names given to special
star groups known as constellations. How many constellations can you correctly
describe?
Column I Column II
Zodiac Names Constellation
15
What you will do
Self-Test 2.1
Connect the stars following the number sequence then name the
constellation.
1 2
6 7
5
3 4 1
2
4
5 3
6
5
5 1
2 7
4 8
9
6 3
1 10
4 11
12
2 13
3
14
15 16
17
16
Let’s summarize
What are the things that you have learned from this module?
1. Scientists believe that all stars came from huge clouds of gas and dust
called nebulae.
2. The nuclear fusion is the reaction that converts hydrogen atoms into
helium atoms releasing a tremendous amount of heat, causing the star
to glow.
3. A protostar is a very young star. It becomes a true star when nuclear
fusion starts.
4. The star is considered old when it has reached the red giant phase that
eventually explodes and turns into a dim, cool object.
5. The explosion of a massive star is called supernova.
6. The destiny of a star depends on how massive it is. It may become a
white dwarf, a neutron star, or a black hole.
7. The color of the star indicates its surface temperature. Blue is the color
of the hottest star.
8. A light year is the standard unit of distance for deep sky objects like
stars. One light year is equal to 9,460,800,000,000 kilometers away
from the earth. Other than the sun, Proxima Centauri is the nearest to
earth.
Posttest
Multiple Choice: Write the letter of the best answer before each number.
Multiple Choice: Write the letter of the best answer on the space provided.
17
2. How far away in light years is our nearest star, Proxima Centauri?
a. 2.2
b. 4.3
c. 5.5
d. 6.0
a. nuclear fision
b. nuclear fusion
c. star explosion
d. nitrogen combustion
8. Most astronomers agree that the stars are born within huge clouds of dust and
gases called
a. sun
b. pulsars
c. auroras
d. nebulae
18
9. Which of the following statements is true?
a. The higher the magnitude number, the brighter the star.
b. The lower the magnitude number, the dimmer the star.
c. The lower the magnitude number, the brighter the star.
d. All statements are true.
12. Which of the following units is used in measuring the distance of a star from
the Earth?
a. mile
b. inch
c. kilometer
d. light year
19
Key to Answers
Pretest
1. B
2. B
3. D
4. C
5. D
6. B
7. D
8. C
9. B
10. D
11. C
12. C
13. A
14. D
15. D
(Part 1) Rank 2, 4, 1, 3, 5
(Part 2) Rank 3, 1, 4, 2, 7, 6, 5
The persons’ age can be identified just by looking at persons’ size and
appearance. The age of the stars in the pictures can also be classified based on
their sizes and general appearance. The descriptions and activities of each star
are given to help you in classifying.
20
Convert 27,120,960,000,000 seconds to hour, then to a day then to a
year. The answer is 8 years and 6 months.
Self-Test 1.1
H Crab
O Goat
F Bull
I Twins
E Dragon
L Archer
G Fish
A Lion
B Ram
D Scales
C Hunter
M Scorpion
N Great Bear
K Winged Horse
J Water Carrier
Posttest
1. B
2. B
3. C
4. D
5. C
6. B
7. D
8. D
9. C
10. B
11. A
12. D
13. D
14. C
15. D
21
Self-Test 2.1
1 2
6 7
5
3 4 1
2
4
A) Cassiopeia 5 3
B) Ursa Minor
6
5
1
2 7
4 8
9
3
10
11
12
13
14
15 16
C) Cepheus 17
3.
D) Dragon
-End of Module-
22
References
Temperature and Colors of the Stars. (1999). Monterey Institute for Research in Astronomy. Retrieve
September 13, 2004 from http://www.mira.org/fts0/stars/114/txt001w.htm
Bill Baity, (1996), Star Brightness, Retrieved September 15, 2004 from
http://casswww.ucsd.edu/public/bright.html
Hewitt, H., Suchocki, J., and Hewitt, L. (2000) Conceptual Physical Science.( 2nd Ed).USA. Pearson Education
Asia Pte Ltd.
Starry Night (2003). Your Daily Guide to Philippine Night Sky (2nd Edition)
23